1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H 2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H 3 /* 4 * 802.11 netlink interface public header 5 * 6 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <[email protected]> 7 * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <[email protected]> 8 * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <[email protected]> 9 * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <[email protected]> 10 * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <[email protected]> 11 * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <[email protected]> 12 * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <[email protected]> 13 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 14 * Copyright (C) 2018-2023 Intel Corporation 15 * 16 * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any 17 * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above 18 * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies. 19 * 20 * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES 21 * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF 22 * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR 23 * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES 24 * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN 25 * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF 26 * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE. 27 * 28 */ 29 30 /* 31 * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please 32 * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so 33 * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI. 34 * 35 * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in 36 * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there 37 * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are 38 * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API 39 * can actually be identified and removed. 40 * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file. 41 */ 42 43 #include <linux/types.h> 44 45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211" 46 47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG "config" 48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN "scan" 49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG "regulatory" 50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME "mlme" 51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR "vendor" 52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN "nan" 53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE "testmode" 54 55 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN 4 56 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX 15 57 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN 1 58 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX 0x3c /* 0b00111100 */ 59 60 /** 61 * DOC: Station handling 62 * 63 * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN 64 * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved 65 * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN). 66 * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added 67 * to. 68 * 69 * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's 70 * capabilities. 71 * 72 * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS 73 * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows: 74 * - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate 75 * or capability information, this just exists to avoid race conditions 76 * - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid 77 * to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same 78 * time mark it authorized. 79 * - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used 80 * - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down 81 * the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK) 82 * 83 * TODO: need more info for other interface types 84 */ 85 86 /** 87 * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support 88 * 89 * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace 90 * management entities such as wpa_supplicant react to management frames 91 * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example, 92 * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel 93 * for various reasons. 94 * 95 * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations 96 * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to 97 * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a 98 * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those 99 * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the 100 * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility 101 * for doing that. 102 * 103 * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the 104 * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy 105 * attributes so applications know what to expect. 106 * 107 * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active, 108 * these registrations are ignored until the interface type is 109 * changed again. This means that changing the interface type can 110 * lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but 111 * any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they 112 * will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames. 113 * 114 * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required 115 * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking, 116 * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame was transmitted, its 117 * status is indicated to the sending socket. 118 * 119 * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions 120 * below. 121 */ 122 123 /** 124 * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities 125 * 126 * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs, they can have 127 * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this 128 * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions 129 * on the types of concurrency that are supported. 130 * 131 * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in 132 * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the 133 * types there no concurrency is implied. 134 * 135 * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed: 136 * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in 137 * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's 138 * an additional list of these, they can be added at any time and 139 * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN 140 * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list 141 * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute. 142 * 143 * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is 144 * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically, 145 * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the 146 * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of 147 * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions 148 * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported 149 * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially 150 * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs. 151 * 152 * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual 153 * interfaces that a given device supports. 154 */ 155 156 /** 157 * DOC: packet coalesce support 158 * 159 * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast 160 * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the 161 * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing 162 * and power consumption. 163 * 164 * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts 165 * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some 166 * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the 167 * following events occur. 168 * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum 169 * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule. 170 * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches its limit. 171 * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules. 172 * 173 * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce 174 * rule. 175 * a) Maximum coalescing delay 176 * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched 177 * c) Condition for coalescence. pattern 'match' or 'no match' 178 * Multiple such rules can be created. 179 */ 180 181 /** 182 * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload 183 * 184 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers 185 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2 186 * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 187 * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers 188 * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no 189 * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does 190 * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY. 191 * 192 * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be 193 * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL 194 * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to 195 * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have 196 * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this 197 * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is 198 * not present. 199 * 200 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers 201 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2 202 * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP 203 * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers 204 * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no 205 * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does 206 * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY. 207 * 208 * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK 209 * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also 210 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided. 211 */ 212 213 /** 214 * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload 215 * 216 * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertized by drivers by 217 * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support 218 * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the 219 * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and 220 * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional 221 * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in 222 * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS. 223 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai 224 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai 225 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message 226 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK 227 * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and 228 * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA. 229 * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used 230 * as specified in IETF RFC 6696. 231 * 232 * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the 233 * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting 234 * up a connection or after roaming. 235 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal 236 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges 237 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated 238 * %Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace 239 * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used 240 * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also. 241 * 242 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertized by a FILS 243 * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the 244 * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and 245 * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based 246 * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with 247 * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to 248 * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching. 249 */ 250 251 /** 252 * DOC: SAE authentication offload 253 * 254 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they 255 * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station 256 * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by 257 * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode. 258 * 259 * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in 260 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode 261 * respectively. 262 */ 263 264 /** 265 * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs 266 * 267 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they 268 * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a 269 * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs 270 * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet 271 * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are 272 * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through 273 * that main netdev. 274 * 275 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and 276 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using 277 * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID. 278 */ 279 280 /** 281 * DOC: TID configuration 282 * 283 * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG 284 * attribute given in wiphy capabilities. 285 * 286 * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in 287 * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the 288 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG. 289 * 290 * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC 291 * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the 292 * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except 293 * any peers that have peer specific configuration for the TID by default; if 294 * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer specific values 295 * will be overwritten. 296 * 297 * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection 298 * i.e. the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back 299 * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when 300 * the interface goes down. 301 */ 302 303 /** 304 * DOC: FILS shared key crypto offload 305 * 306 * This feature is applicable to drivers running in AP mode. 307 * 308 * FILS shared key crypto offload can be advertised by drivers by setting 309 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support 310 * FILS shared key crypto offload should be able to encrypt and decrypt 311 * association frames for FILS shared key authentication as per IEEE 802.11ai. 312 * With this capability, for FILS key derivation, drivers depend on userspace. 313 * 314 * After FILS key derivation, userspace shares the FILS AAD details with the 315 * driver and the driver stores the same to use in decryption of association 316 * request and in encryption of association response. The below parameters 317 * should be given to the driver in %NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD. 318 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC - STA MAC address, used for storing FILS AAD per STA 319 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - Used for encryption or decryption 320 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - Used for encryption or decryption 321 * (STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes) 322 * 323 * Once the association is done, the driver cleans the FILS AAD data. 324 */ 325 326 /** 327 * DOC: Multi-Link Operation 328 * 329 * In Multi-Link Operation, a connection between two MLDs utilizes multiple 330 * links. To use this in nl80211, various commands and responses now need 331 * to or will include the new %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS attribute. 332 * Additionally, various commands that need to operate on a specific link 333 * now need to be given the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute, e.g. to 334 * use %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or similar functions. 335 */ 336 337 /** 338 * DOC: OWE DH IE handling offload 339 * 340 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD flag, drivers can indicate 341 * kernel/application space to avoid DH IE handling. When this flag is 342 * advertised, the driver/device will take care of DH IE inclusion and 343 * processing of peer DH IE to generate PMK. 344 */ 345 346 /** 347 * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands 348 * 349 * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors 350 * 351 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request 352 * to get a list of all present wiphys. 353 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or 354 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME, 355 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, 356 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the 357 * channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel), 358 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG, 359 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or 360 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD. However, for setting the channel, 361 * see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward 362 * compatibility only. 363 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request 364 * or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and 365 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME. 366 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes 367 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME. 368 * 369 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration; 370 * either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a 371 * single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported. 372 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires 373 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE. 374 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response 375 * to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX, 376 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also 377 * be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface, 378 * then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and 379 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME. 380 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes 381 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from 382 * userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires 383 * attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. If multiple BSSID advertisements are 384 * enabled using %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS, 385 * and if this command is used for the transmitting interface, then all 386 * the non-transmitting interfaces are deleted as well. 387 * 388 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified 389 * by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 390 * represents peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. For MLO group key, 391 * the link is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID. 392 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT, 393 * %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD. 394 * For MLO connection, the link to set default key is identified by 395 * %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID. 396 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA, 397 * %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER, 398 * and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents 399 * peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. The link to add MLO 400 * group key is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID. 401 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX 402 * or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents peer's MLD address 403 * for MLO pairwise key. The link to delete group key is identified by 404 * %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID. 405 * 406 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used) 407 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface 408 * using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL 409 * attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses 410 * internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE, 411 * %NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP. 412 * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters 413 * are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that 414 * do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL, 415 * %NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, 416 * %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE, 417 * %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS, 418 * %NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY, 419 * %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT, 420 * %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS. 421 * The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the 422 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the 423 * attributes determining channel width. 424 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP 425 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface 426 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP 427 * 428 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by 429 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 430 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by 431 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 432 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the 433 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 434 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 435 * or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified 436 * by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. For MLD station, MLD address is used in 437 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and 438 * %NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type 439 * of disconnection indication should be sent to the station 440 * (Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that 441 * frame). 442 * 443 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to 444 * destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by 445 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 446 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH: Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to 447 * destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by 448 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 449 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by 450 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP. 451 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by 452 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. 453 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the 454 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 455 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 456 * or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified 457 * by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 458 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by 459 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 460 * 461 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set 462 * regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device 463 * has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the 464 * global regdomain will be returned. 465 * A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the 466 * regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel 467 * information will still be mended according to further hints from 468 * the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API 469 * is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as 470 * all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it). 471 * If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then 472 * its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory 473 * core is not used to help with compliance in this case. 474 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command 475 * after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory 476 * domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our 477 * current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides 478 * NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each 479 * regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes given by 480 * %NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and 481 * %NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by 482 * %NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and 483 * %NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP. 484 * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain 485 * to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will 486 * store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it. 487 * 488 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the 489 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX 490 * 491 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the 492 * interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX 493 * 494 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The 495 * interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management 496 * frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be 497 * added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with 498 * %NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be 499 * added to all specified management frames generated by 500 * kernel/firmware/driver. 501 * Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this 502 * point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this 503 * command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the 504 * option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN, 505 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE, 506 * NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE. 507 * 508 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results 509 * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters 510 * %NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the 511 * probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to 512 * specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will 513 * be used. 514 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to 515 * NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group) 516 * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons, 517 * partial scan results may be available 518 * 519 * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain 520 * intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by 521 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is 522 * not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified, 523 * scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval. 524 * These attributes are mutually exculsive, 525 * i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if 526 * NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined. 527 * If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan 528 * plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet). 529 * Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS) 530 * are passed, they are used in the probe requests. For 531 * broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty 532 * string). If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and 533 * a passive scan is performed. %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES, 534 * if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not 535 * passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain 536 * are used. Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by 537 * using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute. The first cycle of the 538 * scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY 539 * is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled 540 * scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute 541 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it. 542 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if 543 * scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon 544 * as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again. 545 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan 546 * results available. 547 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has 548 * stopped. The driver may issue this event at any time during a 549 * scheduled scan. One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware 550 * does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running 551 * a scheduled scan. This event is also sent when the 552 * %NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface 553 * is brought down while a scheduled scan was running. 554 * 555 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey resuls, e.g. channel occupation 556 * or noise level 557 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to 558 * NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group) 559 * 560 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 561 * (for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK 562 * (PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or 563 * using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, 564 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS 565 * authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier 566 * advertized by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an 567 * ESS. 568 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 569 * (for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, 570 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS 571 * authentication. 572 * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries. 573 * 574 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain 575 * has been changed and provides details of the request information 576 * that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request 577 * (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx 578 * (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if 579 * the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or 580 * %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain 581 * set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is 582 * %NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on 583 * to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2). 584 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon 585 * has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or 586 * any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel 587 * where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example 588 * if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your 589 * driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while 590 * doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not 591 * on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP 592 * or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will 593 * never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always 594 * enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had 595 * either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to 596 * userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from 597 * (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred 598 * before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER) 599 * the beacon hint was processed. 600 * 601 * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification. 602 * This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and 603 * as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the 604 * authentication process. 605 * When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the 606 * interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and 607 * BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify 608 * the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication 609 * request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ + 610 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequence of the 611 * channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the 612 * authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs 613 * (VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added 614 * to the frame. 615 * When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication 616 * frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the 617 * frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct 618 * state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the 619 * MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The 620 * included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame 621 * (including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is 622 * also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that 623 * case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a 624 * %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which 625 * pending authentication timed out). 626 * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like 627 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation 628 * (similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request, 629 * MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The 630 * %NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the 631 * request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not 632 * included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is 633 * included). 634 * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like 635 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to 636 * MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication 637 * primitives). 638 * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like 639 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to 640 * MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives). 641 * 642 * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael 643 * MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the 644 * event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of 645 * the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key 646 * type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and 647 * %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this 648 * event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive 649 * 650 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a 651 * FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found) 652 * and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those 653 * should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be 654 * executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ 655 * may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval, 656 * given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not 657 * given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms). 658 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is 659 * determined by the network interface. 660 * 661 * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute 662 * to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through 663 * to the driver. 664 * 665 * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command 666 * requests to connect to a specified network but without separating 667 * auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a 668 * %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association 669 * IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, 670 * %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, 671 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT, 672 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, 673 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT, 674 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and 675 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT. 676 * If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are 677 * restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming 678 * within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT 679 * can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while 680 * allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to 681 * ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one 682 * set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing 683 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict 684 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT). 685 * Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if 686 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is 687 * included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user 688 * space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends 689 * up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g. 690 * userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the 691 * driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE 692 * has to get updated with the apt PMKID). 693 * %NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within 694 * the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with 695 * a different BSS is desired. 696 * Background scan period can optionally be 697 * specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD, 698 * if not specified default background scan configuration 699 * in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled. 700 * This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan. 701 * It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the 702 * connection is established or failed to be established. This can be 703 * determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success, 704 * non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the 705 * event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate 706 * authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP. 707 * Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as 708 * well to remain backwards compatible. 709 * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself. 710 * When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using 711 * fast transition, this event should be followed by an 712 * %NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event. 713 * Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue 714 * %NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the 715 * new BSS the card/driver roamed to. 716 * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify 717 * userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other 718 * reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and 719 * %NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used. 720 * 721 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices 722 * associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow. 723 * 724 * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified 725 * channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do 726 * off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for 727 * a response while being associated to an AP on another channel. 728 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus 729 * radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the 730 * frequency for the operation. 731 * %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds 732 * to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to 733 * notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the 734 * driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the 735 * radio). 736 * When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) 737 * that will be included with any events pertaining to this request; 738 * the cookie is also used to cancel the request. 739 * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a 740 * pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been 741 * completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration. 742 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the 743 * radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to 744 * uniquely identify the request. 745 * This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested 746 * remain-on-channel duration has expired. 747 * 748 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX 749 * rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface 750 * and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates. 751 * 752 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames 753 * (via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command 754 * requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for 755 * backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames) 756 * and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame 757 * that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or 758 * four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration 759 * cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink 760 * socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made. 761 * The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if 762 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which 763 * case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the 764 * flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it. 765 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for 766 * backward compatibility 767 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This 768 * command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and 769 * as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in 770 * kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a 771 * user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the 772 * frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used 773 * to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was 774 * received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel 775 * or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel 776 * and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time 777 * specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation 778 * returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the 779 * TX status event pertaining to the TX request. 780 * %NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the 781 * management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band. 782 * %NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA 783 * counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute 784 * is used during CSA period. 785 * For TX on an MLD, the frequency can be omitted and the link ID be 786 * specified, or if transmitting to a known peer MLD (with MLD addresses 787 * in the frame) both can be omitted and the link will be selected by 788 * lower layers. 789 * For RX notification, %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to 790 * indicate the frame RX timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may 791 * be included to indicate the ack TX timestamp. 792 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this 793 * command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait 794 * time if it is known that it is no longer necessary. This command is 795 * also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel 796 * wait time. 797 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility. 798 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame 799 * transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies 800 * the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the 801 * frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged 802 * the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to indicate the 803 * tx timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to 804 * indicate the ack RX timestamp. 805 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for 806 * backward compatibility. 807 * 808 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE 809 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE 810 * 811 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command 812 * is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger 813 * levels. 814 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This 815 * command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was 816 * reached. 817 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 818 * and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface 819 * (identifed by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on. 820 * In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism 821 * with which it switches channels is implementation-defined. 822 * When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while 823 * no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation 824 * of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take 825 * precedence when they are used. 826 * 827 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface 828 * (no longer supported). 829 * 830 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform 831 * multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets 832 * with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header) 833 * will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast) 834 * MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may 835 * break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop 836 * unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability 837 * to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases. 838 * This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of 839 * type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces 840 * (%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode. 841 * If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this 842 * command, the feature is disabled. 843 * 844 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial 845 * mesh config parameters may be given. 846 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the 847 * network is determined by the network interface. 848 * 849 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame 850 * notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected 851 * deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use. 852 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame 853 * notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected 854 * disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use. 855 * 856 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a 857 * beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer. This is only 858 * sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer 859 * candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH, 860 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or 861 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set. On reception of this 862 * notification, userspace may decide to create a new station 863 * (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). To stop this notification from 864 * reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the 865 * new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later 866 * depending on the authentication result. 867 * 868 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings. 869 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings. 870 * Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports 871 * various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this 872 * command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For 873 * more background information, see 874 * https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN. 875 * The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification 876 * from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the 877 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason 878 * for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present 879 * in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the 880 * wakeup but reports that it was woken up. 881 * 882 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver 883 * the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This 884 * feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data 885 * is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and 886 * contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened, 887 * this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to 888 * inform userspace of the new replay counter. 889 * 890 * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace 891 * of PMKSA caching dandidates. 892 * 893 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup). 894 * In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take 895 * actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one). 896 * In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested 897 * operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and 898 * %NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with 899 * %NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN). 900 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The 901 * %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be 902 * sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as 903 * 802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012 904 * 8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently 905 * supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES 906 * and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in 907 * &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode. 908 * 909 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP 910 * (or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to 911 * implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3 912 * frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame 913 * is received. 914 * For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and 915 * other attributes like the interface index are present. 916 * If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can 917 * only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription 918 * is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events. 919 * 920 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the 921 * associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame 922 * and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly 923 * to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener. 924 * 925 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface 926 * by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is 927 * acknowleged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses 928 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a 929 * direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match 930 * up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and 931 * has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed. 932 * 933 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from 934 * other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement 935 * OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME 936 * messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register. 937 * 938 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether 939 * No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied. 940 * 941 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels 942 * independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating 943 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the 944 * attributes determining channel width. This indication may also be 945 * sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA 946 * from the remote AP) is completed; 947 * 948 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch 949 * has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator 950 * (ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or 951 * initiated on our own). It indicates that 952 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 953 * after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's. The userspace may 954 * decide to react to this indication by requesting other 955 * interfaces to change channel as well. 956 * 957 * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by 958 * its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with 959 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the 960 * P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and 961 * public action frame TX. 962 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by 963 * its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. 964 * 965 * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to 966 * notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a 967 * station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON 968 * is used for this. 969 * 970 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames 971 * for IBSS or MESH vif. 972 * 973 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control. 974 * This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC 975 * address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in 976 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in 977 * %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it 978 * is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver 979 * will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This 980 * command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its 981 * ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP. 982 * 983 * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once 984 * a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished 985 * or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with 986 * this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars 987 * while operating on this channel. 988 * %NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the 989 * event. 990 * 991 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features, 992 * i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features. 993 * Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap. 994 * 995 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition 996 * Information Element to the WLAN driver 997 * 998 * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver 999 * to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along 1000 * with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report 1001 * received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE). 1002 * 1003 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running 1004 * a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to 1005 * complete. 1006 * 1007 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can 1008 * return back to normal. 1009 * 1010 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules. 1011 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules. 1012 * 1013 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the 1014 * new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA) 1015 * in the beacon for some time (as defined in the 1016 * %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the 1017 * new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using 1018 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel 1019 * width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform 1020 * other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel 1021 * switch is complete. 1022 * 1023 * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified 1024 * by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in 1025 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in 1026 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 1027 * For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is 1028 * used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions 1029 * (&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands. 1030 * This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes. 1031 * 1032 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values. 1033 * The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If 1034 * that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this 1035 * QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an 1036 * association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart. 1037 * 1038 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given 1039 * %NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO 1040 * and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters. 1041 * Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by 1042 * userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets 1043 * up the TX TS in the driver/device. 1044 * If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks 1045 * if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to 1046 * avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would 1047 * make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still 1048 * fail even if the check was successful. 1049 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID 1050 * and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this 1051 * before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating 1052 * or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case. 1053 * 1054 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to 1055 * destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by 1056 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. 1057 * 1058 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and 1059 * bandwidth of a channel must be given. 1060 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the 1061 * network is determined by the network interface. 1062 * 1063 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer, 1064 * identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is 1065 * provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining 1066 * channel width/type. The target operating class is given via 1067 * %NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS. 1068 * The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching 1069 * operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the 1070 * AP. 1071 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS 1072 * peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel 1073 * when this command completes. 1074 * 1075 * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used 1076 * as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom 1077 * management. 1078 * 1079 * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is 1080 * not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through 1081 * cfg80211_scan_done(). 1082 * 1083 * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its 1084 * %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been 1085 * previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it 1086 * has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a 1087 * cluster. This command must have a valid 1088 * %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional 1089 * %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes. If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is 1090 * omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will 1091 * decide what to use. After this command NAN functions can be 1092 * added. 1093 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by 1094 * its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. 1095 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined 1096 * with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this 1097 * operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id 1098 * (%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) 1099 * of the function upon success. 1100 * Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right 1101 * way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination 1102 * event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new 1103 * function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one 1104 * which just terminated. 1105 * This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command 1106 * returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes 1107 * the response to this command. 1108 * Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well. 1109 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie. 1110 * This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is 1111 * terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID 1112 * and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes. 1113 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN 1114 * configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN 1115 * was executed). It must contain at least one of the following 1116 * attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF, 1117 * %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS. If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the 1118 * current configuration is not changed. If it is present but 1119 * set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care 1120 * (i.e. the device can decide what to do). 1121 * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported. 1122 * This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and 1123 * %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE. 1124 * 1125 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters 1126 * for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal 1127 * BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it 1128 * does not result in a change for the current association. Currently, 1129 * only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command. 1130 * 1131 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0 1132 * for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC). 1133 * When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the 1134 * PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK. 1135 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously 1136 * configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by 1137 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. 1138 * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates port is authorized and 1139 * open for regular data traffic. For STA/P2P-client, this event is sent 1140 * with AP MAC address and for AP/P2P-GO, the event carries the STA/P2P- 1141 * client MAC address. 1142 * Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload should send this event for 1143 * STA/P2P-client after successful 4-way HS or after 802.1X FT following 1144 * NL80211_CMD_CONNECT or NL80211_CMD_ROAM. Drivers using AP/P2P-GO 4-way 1145 * handshake offload should send this event on successful completion of 1146 * 4-way handshake with the peer (STA/P2P-client). 1147 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request 1148 * and RX notification. This command is used both as a request to transmit 1149 * a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame 1150 * has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the 1151 * frame contents. The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or 1152 * 802.11 headers. 1153 * For an MLD transmitter, the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID may be given and 1154 * its effect will depend on the destination: If the destination is known 1155 * to be an MLD, this will be used as a hint to select the link to transmit 1156 * the frame on. If the destination is not an MLD, this will select both 1157 * the link to transmit on and the source address will be set to the link 1158 * address of that link. 1159 * When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, 1160 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added 1161 * indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame 1162 * was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively. 1163 * 1164 * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded. 1165 * 1166 * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host 1167 * drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and 1168 * association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen. 1169 * This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space) 1170 * to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to 1171 * driver) to indicate the authentication status. 1172 * 1173 * User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to 1174 * trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses 1175 * this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user 1176 * space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user 1177 * space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds 1178 * further with the association after getting successful authentication 1179 * status. User space indicates the authentication status through 1180 * %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH 1181 * command interface. 1182 * 1183 * Host driver sends MLD address of the AP with %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR in 1184 * %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH event to indicate user space to enable MLO 1185 * during the authentication offload in STA mode while connecting to MLD 1186 * APs. Host driver should check %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT flag capability 1187 * in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space supports enabling 1188 * MLO during the authentication offload or not. 1189 * User space should enable MLO during the authentication only when it 1190 * receives the AP MLD address in authentication offload request. User 1191 * space shouldn't enable MLO when the authentication offload request 1192 * doesn't indicate the AP MLD address even if the AP is MLO capable. 1193 * User space should use %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR as peer's MLD address and 1194 * interface address identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX as self MLD 1195 * address. User space and host driver to use MLD addresses in RA, TA and 1196 * BSSID fields of the frames between them, and host driver translates the 1197 * MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link chosen for the 1198 * authentication. 1199 * 1200 * Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the 1201 * user space through the connect result as the user space would have 1202 * initiated the connection through the connect request. 1203 * 1204 * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's 1205 * ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE, 1206 * %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its 1207 * address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC). 1208 * 1209 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in 1210 * the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute. 1211 * 1212 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s) 1213 * with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested 1214 * %NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address 1215 * randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the 1216 * %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes. 1217 * If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute. 1218 * A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in 1219 * the netlink extended ack message. 1220 * 1221 * To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it. 1222 * 1223 * Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the 1224 * measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they 1225 * become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket 1226 * buffer size. 1227 * 1228 * Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start 1229 * multiple concurrent measurements. 1230 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the 1231 * result notification from the driver to the requesting socket. 1232 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that 1233 * the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie 1234 * (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE). 1235 * 1236 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was 1237 * detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel 1238 * indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes 1239 * determining the width and type. 1240 * 1241 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to 1242 * offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support 1243 * OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely 1244 * on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode. 1245 * 1246 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric 1247 * refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data 1248 * frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a 1249 * primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of 1250 * the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some 1251 * form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be 1252 * properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the 1253 * regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data 1254 * so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for 1255 * rate selection. 1256 * 1257 * Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh 1258 * peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame 1259 * content. The frame is ethernet data. 1260 * 1261 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration 1262 * is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute. 1263 * 1264 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon 1265 * frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was 1266 * dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon 1267 * protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). 1268 * 1269 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control 1270 * port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME. 1271 * %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME 1272 * includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included 1273 * if the recipient acknowledged the frame. 1274 * 1275 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is 1276 * passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to 1277 * specify the wiphy index to be applied to. 1278 * 1279 * @NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION: This notification is sent out whenever 1280 * mac80211/drv detects a bss color collision. 1281 * 1282 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST: This command is used to indicate that 1283 * userspace wants to change the BSS color. 1284 * 1285 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED: Notify userland, that a color change has 1286 * started 1287 * 1288 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED: Notify userland, that the color change has 1289 * been aborted 1290 * 1291 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED: Notify userland that the color change 1292 * has completed 1293 * 1294 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD: Set FILS AAD data to the driver using - 1295 * &NL80211_ATTR_MAC - for STA MAC address 1296 * &NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - for KEK 1297 * &NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - for FILS Nonces 1298 * (STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes) 1299 * 1300 * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK: notification about an association 1301 * temporal rejection with comeback. The event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 1302 * to describe the BSSID address of the AP and %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT to 1303 * specify the timeout value. 1304 * 1305 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK: Add a new link to an interface. The 1306 * %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute is used for the new link. 1307 * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK: Remove a link from an interface. This may come 1308 * without %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID as an easy way to remove all links 1309 * in preparation for e.g. roaming to a regular (non-MLO) AP. 1310 * 1311 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA: Add a link to an MLD station 1312 * @NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA: Modify a link of an MLD station 1313 * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA: Remove a link of an MLD station 1314 * 1315 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP: Enable/disable HW timestamping of Timing 1316 * measurement and Fine timing measurement frames. If %NL80211_ATTR_MAC 1317 * is included, enable/disable HW timestamping only for frames to/from the 1318 * specified MAC address. Otherwise enable/disable HW timestamping for 1319 * all TM/FTM frames (including ones that were enabled with specific MAC 1320 * address). If %NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED is not included, disable 1321 * HW timestamping. 1322 * The number of peers that HW timestamping can be enabled for concurrently 1323 * is indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS. 1324 * 1325 * @NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED: Notify userspace about the removal of STA MLD 1326 * setup links due to AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with 1327 * Multi-Link reconfiguration. %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS is used to provide 1328 * information about the removed STA MLD setup links. 1329 * 1330 * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number 1331 * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use 1332 */ 1333 enum nl80211_commands { 1334 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */ 1335 NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC, 1336 1337 NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, /* can dump */ 1338 NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY, 1339 NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY, 1340 NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY, 1341 1342 NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE, /* can dump */ 1343 NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE, 1344 NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE, 1345 NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE, 1346 1347 NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY, 1348 NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY, 1349 NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY, 1350 NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY, 1351 1352 NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON, 1353 NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, 1354 NL80211_CMD_START_AP, 1355 NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP, 1356 NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP, 1357 NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP, 1358 1359 NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, 1360 NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION, 1361 NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, 1362 NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION, 1363 1364 NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, 1365 NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH, 1366 NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH, 1367 NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH, 1368 1369 NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS, 1370 1371 NL80211_CMD_SET_REG, 1372 NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG, 1373 1374 NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG, 1375 NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG, 1376 1377 NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */, 1378 1379 NL80211_CMD_GET_REG, 1380 1381 NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN, 1382 NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN, 1383 NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS, 1384 NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED, 1385 1386 NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, 1387 1388 NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, 1389 NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE, 1390 NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, 1391 NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, 1392 1393 NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE, 1394 1395 NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT, 1396 1397 NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS, 1398 NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS, 1399 1400 NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 1401 1402 NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, 1403 NL80211_CMD_ROAM, 1404 NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT, 1405 1406 NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS, 1407 1408 NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, 1409 NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS, 1410 1411 NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA, 1412 NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA, 1413 NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA, 1414 1415 NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL, 1416 NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL, 1417 1418 NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK, 1419 1420 NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME, 1421 NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME, 1422 NL80211_CMD_FRAME, 1423 NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME, 1424 NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, 1425 NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, 1426 1427 NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE, 1428 NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE, 1429 1430 NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM, 1431 NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM, 1432 1433 NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL, 1434 NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER, 1435 1436 NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL, 1437 1438 NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH, 1439 NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH, 1440 1441 NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE, 1442 NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE, 1443 1444 NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE, 1445 1446 NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN, 1447 NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN, 1448 1449 NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN, 1450 NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN, 1451 NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS, 1452 NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED, 1453 1454 NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD, 1455 1456 NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE, 1457 1458 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER, 1459 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT, 1460 1461 NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME, 1462 1463 NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT, 1464 1465 NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS, 1466 1467 NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME, 1468 1469 NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP, 1470 1471 NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY, 1472 1473 NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE, 1474 NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE, 1475 1476 NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED, 1477 1478 NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE, 1479 1480 NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, 1481 1482 NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT, 1483 1484 NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES, 1485 1486 NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES, 1487 NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT, 1488 1489 NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START, 1490 NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP, 1491 1492 NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE, 1493 NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE, 1494 1495 NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH, 1496 1497 NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 1498 1499 NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP, 1500 1501 NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS, 1502 NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS, 1503 1504 NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP, 1505 1506 NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB, 1507 NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB, 1508 1509 NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY, 1510 1511 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH, 1512 NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH, 1513 1514 NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE, 1515 1516 NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN, 1517 1518 NL80211_CMD_START_NAN, 1519 NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN, 1520 NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION, 1521 NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION, 1522 NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, 1523 NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH, 1524 1525 NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST, 1526 1527 NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS, 1528 1529 NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK, 1530 NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK, 1531 1532 NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED, 1533 1534 NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB, 1535 1536 NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH, 1537 1538 NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED, 1539 1540 NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME, 1541 1542 NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS, 1543 1544 NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START, 1545 NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT, 1546 NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE, 1547 1548 NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR, 1549 1550 NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO, 1551 1552 NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK, 1553 1554 NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG, 1555 1556 NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON, 1557 1558 NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS, 1559 1560 NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS, 1561 1562 NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION, 1563 1564 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST, 1565 1566 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED, 1567 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED, 1568 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED, 1569 1570 NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD, 1571 1572 NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK, 1573 1574 NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK, 1575 NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK, 1576 1577 NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA, 1578 NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA, 1579 NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA, 1580 1581 NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP, 1582 1583 NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED, 1584 1585 /* add new commands above here */ 1586 1587 /* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */ 1588 __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST, 1589 NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1 1590 }; 1591 1592 /* 1593 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them 1594 * here 1595 */ 1596 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS 1597 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE 1598 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE 1599 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE 1600 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE 1601 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE 1602 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE 1603 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT 1604 1605 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS 1606 1607 /* source-level API compatibility */ 1608 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG 1609 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG 1610 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE 1611 1612 /** 1613 * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes 1614 * 1615 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors 1616 * 1617 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf. 1618 * /sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index 1619 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming) 1620 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters 1621 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz, 1622 * defines the channel together with the (deprecated) 1623 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes 1624 * %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 1625 * and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 1626 * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values 1627 * of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the 1628 * documentation of the enum for more information. 1629 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the 1630 * channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the 1631 * operating channel center frequency. 1632 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the 1633 * channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth 1634 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 1635 * if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included): 1636 * NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including 1637 * this attribute) 1638 * NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only 1639 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel 1640 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel 1641 * This attribute is now deprecated. 1642 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is 1643 * less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255; 1644 * dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8 1645 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is 1646 * greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255; 1647 * dot11ShortLongLimit; u8 1648 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum 1649 * length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable 1650 * fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32 1651 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length 1652 * larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range: 1653 * 0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32 1654 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11 1655 * section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8 1656 * 1657 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on 1658 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name 1659 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype 1660 * 1661 * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices 1662 * that don't have a netdev (u64) 1663 * 1664 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses) 1665 * 1666 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of 1667 * 16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC 1668 * keys 1669 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3) 1670 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11 1671 * section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04) 1672 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and 1673 * CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian 1674 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key 1675 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the 1676 * default management key 1677 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or 1678 * other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used 1679 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or 1680 * other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used 1681 * 1682 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU 1683 * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing 1684 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE 1685 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE 1686 * 1687 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16) 1688 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of 1689 * &enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2) 1690 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by 1691 * IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16). 1692 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported 1693 * rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length 1694 * restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES). 1695 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station 1696 * to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to. 1697 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info 1698 * given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing 1699 * info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info. 1700 * 1701 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands, 1702 * consisting of a nested array. 1703 * 1704 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes). 1705 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link 1706 * (see &enum nl80211_plink_action). 1707 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path. 1708 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path 1709 * info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at 1710 * &enum nl80211_mpath_info. 1711 * 1712 * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of 1713 * &enum nl80211_mntr_flags. 1714 * 1715 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the 1716 * current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to. 1717 * For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel 1718 * to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can 1719 * also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set 1720 * regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the 1721 * IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country. 1722 * Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain 1723 * to a specific alpha2. 1724 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory 1725 * rules. 1726 * 1727 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1) 1728 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1729 * (u8, 0 or 1) 1730 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled 1731 * (u8, 0 or 1) 1732 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic 1733 * rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length 1734 * restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES). 1735 * 1736 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from 1737 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) 1738 * 1739 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all 1740 * supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number 1741 * of the interface mode. 1742 * 1743 * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for 1744 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE. 1745 * 1746 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with 1747 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE). 1748 * 1749 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with 1750 * a single scan request, a wiphy attribute. 1751 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can 1752 * scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute. 1753 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements 1754 * that can be added to a scan request 1755 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information 1756 * elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request 1757 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be 1758 * used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute. 1759 * 1760 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz) 1761 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive 1762 * scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan 1763 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS 1764 * 1765 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain 1766 * currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_* 1767 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently 1768 * set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*) 1769 * 1770 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies 1771 * an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number) 1772 * that the driver for the given wiphy supports. 1773 * 1774 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header 1775 * and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and 1776 * NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events 1777 * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets) 1778 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type, 1779 * represented as a u32 1780 * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and 1781 * %NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16 1782 * 1783 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as 1784 * a u32 1785 * 1786 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change 1787 * due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects 1788 * the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This 1789 * attributes consists of a nested attribute containing 1790 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_* 1791 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change 1792 * due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects 1793 * the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This 1794 * attributes consists of a nested attribute containing 1795 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_* 1796 * 1797 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported 1798 * cipher suites 1799 * 1800 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look 1801 * for other networks on different channels 1802 * 1803 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this 1804 * is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event 1805 * 1806 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is 1807 * used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32); 1808 * this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and 1809 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for 1810 * %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it 1811 * must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not. 1812 * Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will 1813 * let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not. 1814 * 1815 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a 1816 * &struct nl80211_sta_flag_update. 1817 * 1818 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls 1819 * IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in 1820 * station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE 1821 * request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until 1822 * authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by 1823 * default in station mode. 1824 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the 1825 * ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be 1826 * specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not 1827 * specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This 1828 * attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to 1829 * indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported. 1830 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with 1831 * %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom 1832 * ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted. 1833 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control 1834 * port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE) 1835 * will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211 1836 * socket. If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending 1837 * control port frames directly to the network interface is used. If the 1838 * flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead 1839 * using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME. If control port routing over NL80211 is 1840 * to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER 1841 * flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth 1842 * frames are not forwared over the control port. 1843 * 1844 * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver. 1845 * We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this. 1846 * 1847 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT 1848 * event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to 1849 * a local disconnect request. 1850 * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 1851 * event (u16) 1852 * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating 1853 * that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to 1854 * indicate that the BSS is to use protection. 1855 * 1856 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON 1857 * to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection 1858 * (an array of u32). 1859 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to 1860 * indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a 1861 * u32). 1862 * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to 1863 * indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using 1864 * (a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions). 1865 * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to 1866 * indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32). 1867 * This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, 1868 * indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which 1869 * implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also 1870 * the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware. 1871 * If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should 1872 * assume the driver supports all the AKM suites. 1873 * 1874 * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as 1875 * sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events. 1876 * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as 1877 * sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events. 1878 * 1879 * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT 1880 * commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use 1881 * Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the 1882 * Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is 1883 * used for the initial association to an ESS. 1884 * 1885 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with 1886 * %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes 1887 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect() 1888 * and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each 1889 * with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes 1890 * 1891 * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace. 1892 * 1893 * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for 1894 * dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being 1895 * dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has 1896 * obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that 1897 * all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it 1898 * changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated 1899 * completely from scratch. 1900 * 1901 * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface 1902 * 1903 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of 1904 * the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute 1905 * containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info. 1906 * 1907 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching. 1908 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can 1909 * cache, a wiphy attribute. 1910 * 1911 * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32. 1912 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that 1913 * specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the 1914 * remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32. 1915 * 1916 * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects. 1917 * 1918 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes 1919 * (enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The 1920 * enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested 1921 * data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all 1922 * rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute 1923 * is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP, 1924 * and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must 1925 * specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon. 1926 * The driver must also specify support for this with the extended 1927 * features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY, 1928 * NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT, 1929 * NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and 1930 * NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE. 1931 * 1932 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain 1933 * at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME. 1934 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the 1935 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command. 1936 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a 1937 * nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing 1938 * information about which frame types can be transmitted with 1939 * %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. 1940 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a 1941 * nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing 1942 * information about which frame types can be registered for RX. 1943 * 1944 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was 1945 * acknowledged by the recipient. 1946 * 1947 * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values. 1948 * 1949 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a 1950 * nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes. 1951 * 1952 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command 1953 * is requesting a local authentication/association state change without 1954 * invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with 1955 * NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, 1956 * NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE. 1957 * 1958 * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations 1959 * connected to this BSS. 1960 * 1961 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See 1962 * &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values. 1963 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units. 1964 * This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING 1965 * for non-automatic settings. 1966 * 1967 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly 1968 * means support for per-station GTKs. 1969 * 1970 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting. 1971 * This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should 1972 * not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this 1973 * bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna. 1974 * 1975 * Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first 1976 * bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n 1977 * drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to 1978 * a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if 1979 * a chain has diversity antennas wether diversity should be used or not. 1980 * HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be 1981 * derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask. 1982 * Non-802.11n drivers can derive wether to use diversity or not. 1983 * Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot 1984 * support by returning -EINVAL. 1985 * 1986 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving. 1987 * This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should 1988 * not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap 1989 * the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna. 1990 * For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX. 1991 * 1992 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available 1993 * for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters. 1994 * 1995 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available 1996 * for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters. 1997 * 1998 * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS 1999 * 2000 * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be 2001 * transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match 2002 * the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this 2003 * flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an 2004 * nl80211 capability flag. 2005 * 2006 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16) 2007 * 2008 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags 2009 * attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as. 2010 * See &enum nl80211_key_default_types. 2011 * 2012 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters. These cannot be 2013 * changed once the mesh is active. 2014 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute 2015 * containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params. 2016 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver 2017 * allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via 2018 * the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag. 2019 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in 2020 * &enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link 2021 * management state machine. @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or 2022 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled. 2023 * 2024 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy 2025 * capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers 2026 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to 2027 * indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also 2028 * used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN 2029 * triggers. 2030 * 2031 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan 2032 * cycles, in msecs. 2033 * 2034 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more 2035 * sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans. Only BSSs 2036 * that match any of the sets will be reported. These are 2037 * pass-thru filter rules. 2038 * For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a 2039 * set. Since not every hardware supports matching all types of 2040 * attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are 2041 * fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be 2042 * able to ignore them by itself. 2043 * Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but 2044 * this is only an optimization and the userspace application 2045 * needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway. 2046 * If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with 2047 * the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID 2048 * is included in the probe request, but the match attributes 2049 * will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned. 2050 * If omitted, no filtering is done. 2051 * 2052 * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported 2053 * interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes 2054 * defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs. 2055 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like 2056 * %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that 2057 * are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to 2058 * any restrictions in their number or combinations. 2059 * 2060 * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information 2061 * necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data. 2062 * 2063 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan, 2064 * nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry 2065 * being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but 2066 * without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES). 2067 * 2068 * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon 2069 * and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see 2070 * &enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32 2071 * 2072 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame. 2073 * This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to 2074 * provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the 2075 * driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames. 2076 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association 2077 * Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and 2078 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into 2079 * (Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to 2080 * (Re)Association Request frames. 2081 * 2082 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration 2083 * of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr. 2084 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working 2085 * as AP. 2086 * 2087 * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of 2088 * roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low. 2089 * 2090 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching 2091 * candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr. 2092 * 2093 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not 2094 * for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action 2095 * frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space 2096 * applications use this attribute. 2097 * This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and 2098 * %NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands. 2099 * 2100 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup 2101 * request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are 2102 * described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification. 2103 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a 2104 * TDLS conversation between two devices. 2105 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see 2106 * &enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8. 2107 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate 2108 * as a TDLS peer sta. 2109 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown 2110 * procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via 2111 * %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 2112 * used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation. 2113 * 2114 * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices 2115 * that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated 2116 * with support for the features listed in this attribute, see 2117 * &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 2118 * 2119 * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells 2120 * the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this, 2121 * it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is 2122 * mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime. 2123 * 2124 * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from 2125 * &enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information. 2126 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe 2127 * requests while operating in AP-mode. 2128 * This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for 2129 * offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr). 2130 * 2131 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire 2132 * probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out, 2133 * to be filled by the FW. 2134 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable 2135 * this feature during association. This is a flag attribute. 2136 * Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers. 2137 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable 2138 * this feature during association. This is a flag attribute. 2139 * Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers. 2140 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable 2141 * this feature during association. This is a flag attribute. 2142 * Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers. 2143 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the 2144 * ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid. 2145 * Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature. 2146 * The values that may be configured are: 2147 * MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40 2148 * AMPDU density and AMPDU factor. 2149 * All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored 2150 * by the driver as required. The actual values may be seen in 2151 * the station debugfs ht_caps file. 2152 * 2153 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country 2154 * abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps 2155 * to one DFS region. 2156 * 2157 * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of 2158 * up to 16 TIDs. 2159 * 2160 * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be 2161 * used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support 2162 * to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from 2163 * the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the 2164 * capability to timeout the stations. 2165 * 2166 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int); 2167 * this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to 2168 * received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. 2169 * 2170 * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds 2171 * or 0 to disable background scan. 2172 * 2173 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from 2174 * userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from 2175 * a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source 2176 * was used to provide the hint. For the different types of 2177 * allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type. 2178 * 2179 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected 2180 * the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason 2181 * enum has different reasons of connection failure. 2182 * 2183 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. 2184 * This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), 2185 * excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the 2186 * Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with 2187 * authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into 2188 * the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the 2189 * initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and 2190 * Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data 2191 * for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition 2192 * consistent. 2193 * 2194 * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from 2195 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) 2196 * 2197 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32) 2198 * 2199 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with 2200 * the START_AP and SET_BSS commands 2201 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the 2202 * START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1; 2203 * if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS 2204 * no change is made. 2205 * 2206 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode 2207 * defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode. 2208 * 2209 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy, 2210 * carried in a u32 attribute 2211 * 2212 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for 2213 * MAC ACL. 2214 * 2215 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum 2216 * number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC 2217 * ACL. 2218 * 2219 * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace, 2220 * contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32). 2221 * 2222 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver 2223 * has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See 2224 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information. 2225 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver 2226 * has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields. 2227 * 2228 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to 2229 * the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD). 2230 * 2231 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are 2232 * advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations 2233 * and PU-APSD. 2234 * 2235 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see 2236 * &enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32. 2237 * 2238 * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports 2239 * receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple 2240 * messages, given with wiphy dump message 2241 * 2242 * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier 2243 * 2244 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information 2245 * Element 2246 * 2247 * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased 2248 * reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16). 2249 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which 2250 * the connection should have increased reliability (u16). 2251 * 2252 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16). 2253 * This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being 2254 * allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to 2255 * update a TDLS peer STA entry. 2256 * 2257 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information. 2258 * 2259 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's 2260 * until the channel switch event. 2261 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission 2262 * must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch 2263 * operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet 2264 * was requested by the AP. 2265 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information 2266 * for the time while performing a channel switch. 2267 * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel 2268 * switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL). 2269 * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel 2270 * switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP). 2271 * 2272 * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32. 2273 * As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags. 2274 * 2275 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels. 2276 * 2277 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported 2278 * operating classes. 2279 * 2280 * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space 2281 * controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in 2282 * %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS 2283 * channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required 2284 * to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the 2285 * IBSS network. 2286 * 2287 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports 2288 * 5 MHz channel bandwidth. 2289 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports 2290 * 10 MHz channel bandwidth. 2291 * 2292 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode 2293 * Notification Element based on association request when used with 2294 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when 2295 * %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS); 2296 * u8 attribute. 2297 * 2298 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if 2299 * %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet) 2300 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command 2301 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this 2302 * attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement 2303 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy 2304 * info, containing a nested array of possible events 2305 * 2306 * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This 2307 * data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element 2308 * in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97. 2309 * 2310 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS 2311 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS 2312 * 2313 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many 2314 * associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32. 2315 * Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g., 2316 * other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to 2317 * advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt 2318 * to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail. 2319 * 2320 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which 2321 * should be updated when the frame is transmitted. 2322 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum 2323 * supported number of csa counters. 2324 * 2325 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32. 2326 * As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability. 2327 * 2328 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface 2329 * creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket 2330 * that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed. 2331 * If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be 2332 * owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will 2333 * be stopped when the socket is closed. 2334 * If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the 2335 * regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket 2336 * that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be 2337 * cleared when the socket is closed. 2338 * If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed 2339 * if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN 2340 * notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this 2341 * attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN 2342 * multicast group. 2343 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the 2344 * station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed. 2345 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically 2346 * torn down when the socket is closed. 2347 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be 2348 * automatically torn down when the socket is closed. 2349 * If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically 2350 * disabled when the socket is closed. 2351 * 2352 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is 2353 * the TDLS link initiator. 2354 * 2355 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection 2356 * shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be 2357 * used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. 2358 * User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the 2359 * underlying device supports these minimal RRM features: 2360 * %NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES, 2361 * %NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET, 2362 * Or, if global RRM is supported, see: 2363 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM 2364 * If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the 2365 * association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability 2366 * flag in the association request's Capability Info field. 2367 * 2368 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout 2369 * estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack 2370 * %NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower 2371 * drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled 2372 * setting valid value for coverage class. 2373 * 2374 * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute) 2375 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute) 2376 * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds 2377 * (per second) (u16 attribute) 2378 * 2379 * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see 2380 * &enum nl80211_smps_mode. 2381 * 2382 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class 2383 * 2384 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask 2385 * 2386 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device 2387 * is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain 2388 * obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global 2389 * cfg80211 regdomain. 2390 * 2391 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte 2392 * array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum 2393 * nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the 2394 * least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0 2395 * is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1 2396 * of byte 3 (u8 array). 2397 * 2398 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be 2399 * returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY 2400 * may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio 2401 * statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.) 2402 * For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information 2403 * should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters 2404 * over all channels. 2405 * 2406 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a 2407 * scheduled scan is started. Or the delay before a WoWLAN 2408 * net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the 2409 * system is suspended. This value is a u32, in seconds. 2410 2411 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device 2412 * is operating in an indoor environment. 2413 * 2414 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for 2415 * scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute. 2416 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for 2417 * a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute. 2418 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in 2419 * a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute. 2420 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan. 2421 * Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval 2422 * between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely, 2423 * thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval 2424 * between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially. 2425 * Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan. 2426 * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate 2427 * in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request 2428 * connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start 2429 * a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only. 2430 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the 2431 * BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains 2432 * attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what 2433 * BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 2434 * it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for 2435 * BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware. 2436 * 2437 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported 2438 * or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status 2439 * 2440 * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 2441 * 2442 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes: 2443 * %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA, 2444 * %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities and 2445 * other interface-type specific capabilities per interface type. For MLO, 2446 * %NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY and %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS are 2447 * present. 2448 * 2449 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO 2450 * groupID for monitor mode. 2451 * The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each 2452 * group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved), 2453 * each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in 2454 * that group and 0 for not being a member. 2455 * The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for 2456 * each group. 2457 * (smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger 2458 * group numbers on least significant bits.) 2459 * This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode. 2460 * Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO 2461 * groupID data. 2462 * to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero. 2463 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow 2464 * when using MU-MIMO air sniffer. 2465 * to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address 2466 * (e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF) 2467 * 2468 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually 2469 * started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that 2470 * requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this 2471 * attribute must not be included). 2472 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which 2473 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set. 2474 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If 2475 * %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the 2476 * maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with 2477 * measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN 2478 * if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement. 2479 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates 2480 * that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is 2481 * mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration 2482 * and the actual measurement duration may be shorter. 2483 * 2484 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is 2485 * used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state. 2486 * 2487 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by 2488 * %NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with 2489 * %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0. 2490 * Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and 2491 * should not be used during a normal device operation. 2492 * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration. This is a u32 2493 * bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum 2494 * nl80211_band. For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 2495 * would be set. This attribute is used with 2496 * %NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and 2497 * it is optional. If no bands are set, it means don't-care and 2498 * the device will decide what to use. 2499 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See 2500 * &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested 2501 * attribute. 2502 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute. 2503 * See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes. 2504 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame 2505 * protection. 2506 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association 2507 * Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet 2508 * STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 2509 * 2510 * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast 2511 * packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute). 2512 * 2513 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also 2514 * used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID. 2515 * 2516 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which 2517 * other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current 2518 * connected BSS so that they get reported to user space. 2519 * This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to 2520 * other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than 2521 * the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid 2522 * unnecessary wakeups. 2523 * 2524 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in 2525 * the specified band is to be adjusted before doing 2526 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out 2527 * better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure 2528 * value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust. 2529 * 2530 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out. 2531 * u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used, 2532 * e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event. 2533 * 2534 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) 2535 * username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with 2536 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2537 * 2538 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part 2539 * of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with 2540 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2541 * 2542 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number 2543 * to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data 2544 * for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2545 * 2546 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the 2547 * NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and 2548 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK 2549 * from successful FILS authentication and is used with 2550 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2551 * 2552 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertized by a FILS AP 2553 * identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with 2554 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA. 2555 * 2556 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with 2557 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID. 2558 * For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide 2559 * PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X 2560 * authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT 2561 * support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME 2562 * is included as well. 2563 * 2564 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to 2565 * indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests. 2566 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled 2567 * scan request that may be active for the device (u32). 2568 * 2569 * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include 2570 * in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it 2571 * wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake. 2572 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT. 2573 * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved) 2574 * 2575 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external 2576 * authentication operation (u32 attribute with an 2577 * &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the 2578 * %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event. 2579 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user 2580 * space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used 2581 * with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver 2582 * may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability 2583 * is indicated in the respective requests from the user space. (This flag 2584 * attribute deprecated for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP, use 2585 * %NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS) 2586 * 2587 * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated RX_NSS value notified using this 2588 * u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED. 2589 * 2590 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum 2591 * nl80211_txq_stats) 2592 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy. 2593 * The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced. 2594 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the 2595 * TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is 2596 * enforced. 2597 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes 2598 * a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler. 2599 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from 2600 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set 2601 * only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set. 2602 * 2603 * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include 2604 * in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing 2605 * measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as 2606 * possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr 2607 * 2608 * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder 2609 * statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats. 2610 * 2611 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32), 2612 * if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an 2613 * invalid value. 2614 * 2615 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result) 2616 * data, uses nested attributes specified in 2617 * &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs. 2618 * This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information, 2619 * with the appropriate sub-attributes. 2620 * 2621 * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime 2622 * scheduler. 2623 * 2624 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for 2625 * station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for 2626 * possible values. 2627 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This 2628 * allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included, 2629 * the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver 2630 * should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface 2631 * or per-station. 2632 * 2633 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It 2634 * is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading 2635 * SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks. 2636 * 2637 * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support. 2638 * 2639 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection 2640 * functionality. 2641 * 2642 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz 2643 * channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions. 2644 * Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute) 2645 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 2646 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute) 2647 * Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13. 2648 * 2649 * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key 2650 * (u16). 2651 * 2652 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings. 2653 * 2654 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry 2655 * using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This 2656 * attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating 2657 * supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in 2658 * %NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not 2659 * advertised for a specific interface type. 2660 * 2661 * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a 2662 * nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes; 2663 * on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub- 2664 * attributes. 2665 * 2666 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control 2667 * port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames. 2668 * 2669 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32, 2670 * dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value). 2671 * An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. 2672 * Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the 2673 * configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based 2674 * authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE, 2675 * where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE) 2676 * authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP 2677 * authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall 2678 * result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime. 2679 * 2680 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in 2681 * terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME 2682 * (u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional 2683 * parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the 2684 * driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching) 2685 * after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime 2686 * has expired. 2687 * 2688 * Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA 2689 * entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If 2690 * no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration, 2691 * disassociation is still forced. 2692 * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the 2693 * %NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there. 2694 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated 2695 * %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with 2696 * an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET. 2697 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the 2698 * first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1. 2699 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies 2700 * 2701 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from 2702 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). 2703 * 2704 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS 2705 * discovery. It is a nested attribute, see 2706 * &enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty 2707 * nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates. 2708 * 2709 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure 2710 * unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see 2711 * &enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty 2712 * nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates. 2713 * 2714 * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from 2715 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) 2716 * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element 2717 * override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in 2718 * NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 2719 * 2720 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE 2721 * derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication. 2722 * This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from 2723 * &enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism. 2724 * 2725 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when 2726 * used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields 2727 * of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related 2728 * sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs. 2729 * 2730 * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and 2731 * disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP 2732 * is desired. 2733 * 2734 * @NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap of the u64 BSS colors for the 2735 * %NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION event. 2736 * 2737 * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT: u8 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's 2738 * until the color switch event. 2739 * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR: u8 attribute specifying the color that we are 2740 * switching to 2741 * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS: Nested set of attributes containing the IE 2742 * information for the time while performing a color switch. 2743 * 2744 * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG: Nested attribute for multiple BSSID 2745 * advertisements (MBSSID) parameters in AP mode. 2746 * Kernel uses this attribute to indicate the driver's support for MBSSID 2747 * and enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP) to the userspace. 2748 * Userspace should use this attribute to configure per interface MBSSID 2749 * parameters. 2750 * See &enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes for details. 2751 * 2752 * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS: Nested parameter to pass multiple BSSID elements. 2753 * Mandatory parameter for the transmitting interface to enable MBSSID. 2754 * Optional for the non-transmitting interfaces. 2755 * 2756 * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Configure dedicated offchannel chain 2757 * available for radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used 2758 * to transmit or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. 2759 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime 2760 * switching on a different channel during CAC detection on the selected 2761 * radar channel. 2762 * 2763 * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS: u32 attribute contains ap settings flags, 2764 * enumerated in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags. This attribute shall be 2765 * used with %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. 2766 * 2767 * @NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY: EHT Capability information element (from 2768 * association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set 2769 * only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set. 2770 * 2771 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID: A (u8) link ID for use with MLO, to be used with 2772 * various commands that need a link ID to operate. 2773 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS: A nested array of links, each containing some 2774 * per-link information and a link ID. 2775 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR: An MLD address, used with various commands such as 2776 * authenticate/associate. 2777 * 2778 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT: Flag attribute to indicate user space supports MLO 2779 * connection. Used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. If this attribute is not 2780 * included in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT drivers must not perform MLO connection. 2781 * 2782 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES: U16 attribute. Indicates maximum number of 2783 * AKM suites allowed for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and 2784 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. If this 2785 * attribute is not present userspace shall consider maximum number of AKM 2786 * suites allowed as %NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES which is the legacy maximum 2787 * number prior to the introduction of this attribute. 2788 * 2789 * @NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY: EML Capability information (u16) 2790 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS: MLD Capabilities and Operations (u16) 2791 * 2792 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for TX operation in 2793 * nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will 2794 * probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset. 2795 * When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the frame TX 2796 * timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates 2797 * the ack TX timestamp. 2798 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for RX operation in 2799 * nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will 2800 * probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset. 2801 * When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the ack RX 2802 * timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates 2803 * the incoming frame RX timestamp. 2804 * @NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP: Transition Disable bitmap, for subsequent 2805 * (re)associations. 2806 * 2807 * @NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP: (u32) Preamble puncturing bitmap, lowest 2808 * bit corresponds to the lowest 20 MHz channel. Each bit set to 1 2809 * indicates that the sub-channel is punctured. Higher 16 bits are 2810 * reserved. 2811 * 2812 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS: Maximum number of peers that HW 2813 * timestamping can be enabled for concurrently (u16), a wiphy attribute. 2814 * A value of 0xffff indicates setting for all peers (i.e. not specifying 2815 * an address with %NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP) is supported. 2816 * @NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED: Indicates whether HW timestamping should 2817 * be enabled or not (flag attribute). 2818 * 2819 * @NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS: Optional nested attribute for 2820 * reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements. This attribute can be used 2821 * only when NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA is enabled. 2822 * Userspace is responsible for splitting the RNR into multiple 2823 * elements such that each element excludes the non-transmitting 2824 * profiles already included in the MBSSID element 2825 * (%NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS) at the same index. Each EMA beacon 2826 * will be generated by adding MBSSID and RNR elements at the same 2827 * index. If the userspace includes more RNR elements than number of 2828 * MBSSID elements then these will be added in every EMA beacon. 2829 * 2830 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED: Flag attribute indicating that the link is 2831 * disabled. 2832 * 2833 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available 2834 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined 2835 * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 2836 */ 2837 enum nl80211_attrs { 2838 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */ 2839 NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC, 2840 2841 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, 2842 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME, 2843 2844 NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX, 2845 NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME, 2846 NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, 2847 2848 NL80211_ATTR_MAC, 2849 2850 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA, 2851 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, 2852 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER, 2853 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ, 2854 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT, 2855 2856 NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL, 2857 NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, 2858 NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD, 2859 NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL, 2860 2861 NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID, 2862 NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS, 2863 NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL, 2864 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES, 2865 NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN, 2866 NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO, 2867 2868 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS, 2869 2870 NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS, 2871 2872 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID, 2873 NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION, 2874 NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP, 2875 NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO, 2876 2877 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT, 2878 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE, 2879 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME, 2880 2881 NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY, 2882 2883 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES, 2884 2885 NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2, 2886 NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES, 2887 2888 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG, 2889 2890 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES, 2891 2892 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, 2893 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, 2894 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE, 2895 2896 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, 2897 2898 NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE, 2899 NL80211_ATTR_IE, 2900 2901 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS, 2902 2903 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES, 2904 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS, 2905 NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */ 2906 NL80211_ATTR_BSS, 2907 2908 NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR, 2909 NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE, 2910 2911 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS, 2912 2913 NL80211_ATTR_FRAME, 2914 NL80211_ATTR_SSID, 2915 NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, 2916 NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE, 2917 2918 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE, 2919 2920 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN, 2921 NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES, 2922 2923 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE, 2924 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER, 2925 2926 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED, 2927 2928 2929 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, 2930 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG, 2931 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, 2932 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD, 2933 2934 NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT, 2935 2936 NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, 2937 2938 NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2, 2939 2940 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT, 2941 2942 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 2943 2944 NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY, 2945 2946 NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP, 2947 NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE, 2948 2949 NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE, 2950 NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP, 2951 NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS, 2952 NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, 2953 2954 NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE, 2955 NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE, 2956 2957 NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID, 2958 2959 NL80211_ATTR_KEY, 2960 NL80211_ATTR_KEYS, 2961 2962 NL80211_ATTR_PID, 2963 2964 NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR, 2965 2966 NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO, 2967 2968 NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, 2969 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS, 2970 2971 NL80211_ATTR_DURATION, 2972 2973 NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE, 2974 2975 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS, 2976 2977 NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES, 2978 2979 NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH, 2980 2981 NL80211_ATTR_ACK, 2982 2983 NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE, 2984 2985 NL80211_ATTR_CQM, 2986 2987 NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE, 2988 2989 NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE, 2990 2991 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING, 2992 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL, 2993 2994 NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES, 2995 NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES, 2996 NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE, 2997 2998 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, 2999 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT, 3000 3001 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN, 3002 3003 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX, 3004 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX, 3005 3006 NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE, 3007 3008 NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK, 3009 3010 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE, 3011 3012 NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES, 3013 3014 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION, 3015 3016 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP, 3017 3018 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX, 3019 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX, 3020 3021 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH, 3022 NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE, 3023 3024 NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS, 3025 NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, 3026 3027 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL, 3028 3029 NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS, 3030 NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES, 3031 3032 NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA, 3033 3034 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS, 3035 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN, 3036 3037 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES, 3038 3039 NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, 3040 3041 NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP, 3042 NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP, 3043 3044 NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME, 3045 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD, 3046 3047 NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT, 3048 3049 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, 3050 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS, 3051 3052 NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE, 3053 3054 NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE, 3055 3056 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION, 3057 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN, 3058 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION, 3059 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT, 3060 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP, 3061 3062 NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME, 3063 3064 NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK, 3065 3066 NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS, 3067 3068 NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD, 3069 3070 NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP, 3071 3072 NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION, 3073 3074 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT, 3075 NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK, 3076 3077 NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP, 3078 3079 NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT, 3080 3081 NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM, 3082 3083 NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD, 3084 3085 NL80211_ATTR_WDEV, 3086 3087 NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE, 3088 3089 NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON, 3090 3091 NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA, 3092 3093 NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY, 3094 3095 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS, 3096 3097 NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH, 3098 NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1, 3099 NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2, 3100 3101 NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW, 3102 NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS, 3103 3104 NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE, 3105 3106 NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY, 3107 3108 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS, 3109 3110 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX, 3111 3112 NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT, 3113 3114 NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA, 3115 NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, 3116 3117 NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY, 3118 NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY, 3119 3120 NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES, 3121 NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP, 3122 3123 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT, 3124 NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK, 3125 3126 NL80211_ATTR_MDID, 3127 NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC, 3128 3129 NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID, 3130 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION, 3131 3132 NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID, 3133 3134 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE, 3135 3136 NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT, 3137 NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX, 3138 NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES, 3139 NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON, 3140 NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP, 3141 3142 NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS, 3143 3144 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS, 3145 3146 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES, 3147 3148 NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS, 3149 3150 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ, 3151 NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ, 3152 3153 NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF, 3154 3155 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID, 3156 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD, 3157 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 3158 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS, 3159 3160 NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP, 3161 3162 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, 3163 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT, 3164 3165 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA, 3166 3167 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY, 3168 3169 NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER, 3170 3171 NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX, 3172 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS, 3173 3174 NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR, 3175 3176 NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM, 3177 3178 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK, 3179 3180 NL80211_ATTR_TSID, 3181 NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO, 3182 NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME, 3183 3184 NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE, 3185 3186 NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS, 3187 3188 NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK, 3189 3190 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG, 3191 3192 NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES, 3193 3194 NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS, 3195 3196 NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD, 3197 3198 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY, 3199 3200 NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR, 3201 3202 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS, 3203 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL, 3204 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS, 3205 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS, 3206 3207 NL80211_ATTR_PBSS, 3208 3209 NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT, 3210 3211 NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS, 3212 3213 NL80211_ATTR_PAD, 3214 3215 NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA, 3216 3217 NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA, 3218 NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR, 3219 3220 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF, 3221 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID, 3222 NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION, 3223 NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY, 3224 3225 NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID, 3226 3227 NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF, 3228 NL80211_ATTR_BANDS, 3229 NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC, 3230 NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH, 3231 3232 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK, 3233 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES, 3234 3235 NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED, 3236 3237 NL80211_ATTR_BSSID, 3238 3239 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI, 3240 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST, 3241 3242 NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON, 3243 3244 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME, 3245 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM, 3246 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM, 3247 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK, 3248 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, 3249 3250 NL80211_ATTR_PMK, 3251 3252 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI, 3253 NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS, 3254 3255 NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS, 3256 NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME, 3257 NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED, 3258 3259 NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION, 3260 NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT, 3261 3262 NL80211_ATTR_NSS, 3263 NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL, 3264 3265 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, 3266 3267 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS, 3268 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT, 3269 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT, 3270 NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM, 3271 3272 NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY, 3273 3274 NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER, 3275 3276 NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS, 3277 3278 NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT, 3279 3280 NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS, 3281 3282 NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT, 3283 NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING, 3284 NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER, 3285 3286 NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD, 3287 3288 NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER, 3289 3290 NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD, 3291 3292 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS, 3293 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG, 3294 3295 NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID, 3296 3297 NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR, 3298 3299 NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES, 3300 3301 NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG, 3302 3303 NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, 3304 3305 NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME, 3306 NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD, 3307 3308 NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST, 3309 NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, 3310 NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET, 3311 NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, 3312 3313 NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY, 3314 3315 NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY, 3316 3317 NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP, 3318 3319 NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY, 3320 NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK, 3321 3322 NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE, 3323 3324 NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED, 3325 3326 NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC, 3327 3328 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE, 3329 3330 NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP, 3331 3332 NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT, 3333 NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR, 3334 NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS, 3335 3336 NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, 3337 NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS, 3338 3339 NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND, 3340 3341 NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS, 3342 3343 NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY, 3344 3345 NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT, 3346 3347 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS, 3348 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID, 3349 NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR, 3350 3351 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT, 3352 3353 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES, 3354 3355 NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY, 3356 NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS, 3357 3358 NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP, 3359 NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP, 3360 NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP, 3361 3362 NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP, 3363 3364 NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS, 3365 NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED, 3366 3367 NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS, 3368 3369 NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED, 3370 3371 /* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */ 3372 3373 __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3374 NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 3375 NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 3376 }; 3377 3378 /* source-level API compatibility */ 3379 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION 3380 #define NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG 3381 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER 3382 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA 3383 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON 3384 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP 3385 3386 /* 3387 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them 3388 * here 3389 */ 3390 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT 3391 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY 3392 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES 3393 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS 3394 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ 3395 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE 3396 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE 3397 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE 3398 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR 3399 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE 3400 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME 3401 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID 3402 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE 3403 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE 3404 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE 3405 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP 3406 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS 3407 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES 3408 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY 3409 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS 3410 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS 3411 3412 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN 64 3413 3414 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES 32 3415 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES 77 3416 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES 128 3417 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY 0 3418 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY 16 3419 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY 24 3420 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN 26 3421 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN 12 3422 #define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN 16 3423 #define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN 54 3424 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES 5 3425 3426 /* 3427 * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES is obsolete when %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES 3428 * present in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. 3429 */ 3430 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES 2 3431 #define NL80211_EHT_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN 13 3432 #define NL80211_EHT_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN 51 3433 3434 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME 10 3435 3436 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */ 3437 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF -300 3438 3439 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL 1800 3440 3441 /** 3442 * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types 3443 * 3444 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides 3445 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member 3446 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member 3447 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point 3448 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces 3449 * are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing 3450 * AP type interface. 3451 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface 3452 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames 3453 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point 3454 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client 3455 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner 3456 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev 3457 * and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the 3458 * %NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE 3459 * commands to create and destroy one 3460 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS 3461 * This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true 3462 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev) 3463 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined 3464 * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types 3465 * 3466 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE 3467 * to set the type of an interface. 3468 * 3469 */ 3470 enum nl80211_iftype { 3471 NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED, 3472 NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC, 3473 NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION, 3474 NL80211_IFTYPE_AP, 3475 NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN, 3476 NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS, 3477 NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR, 3478 NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT, 3479 NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT, 3480 NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO, 3481 NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE, 3482 NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB, 3483 NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN, 3484 3485 /* keep last */ 3486 NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES, 3487 NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1 3488 }; 3489 3490 /** 3491 * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags 3492 * 3493 * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is 3494 * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.) 3495 * 3496 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3497 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X) 3498 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames 3499 * with short barker preamble 3500 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable 3501 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection 3502 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated 3503 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should 3504 * only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the 3505 * flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and 3506 * attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected 3507 * as errors.) 3508 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers 3509 * that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a 3510 * previously added station into associated state 3511 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined 3512 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3513 */ 3514 enum nl80211_sta_flags { 3515 __NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID, 3516 NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, 3517 NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE, 3518 NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME, 3519 NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP, 3520 NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED, 3521 NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER, 3522 NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED, 3523 3524 /* keep last */ 3525 __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST, 3526 NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1 3527 }; 3528 3529 /** 3530 * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS 3531 * 3532 * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism 3533 * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism 3534 * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values 3535 */ 3536 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status { 3537 NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0, 3538 NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED, 3539 3540 NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS, 3541 }; 3542 3543 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER 3544 3545 /** 3546 * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set 3547 * @mask: mask of station flags to set 3548 * @set: which values to set them to 3549 * 3550 * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags. 3551 */ 3552 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update { 3553 __u32 mask; 3554 __u32 set; 3555 } __attribute__((packed)); 3556 3557 /** 3558 * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval 3559 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec 3560 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec 3561 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec 3562 */ 3563 enum nl80211_he_gi { 3564 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8, 3565 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6, 3566 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2, 3567 }; 3568 3569 /** 3570 * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field 3571 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1xLTF: 3.2 usec 3572 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2xLTF: 6.4 usec 3573 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4xLTF: 12.8 usec 3574 */ 3575 enum nl80211_he_ltf { 3576 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF, 3577 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF, 3578 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF, 3579 }; 3580 3581 /** 3582 * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values 3583 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation 3584 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation 3585 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation 3586 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation 3587 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation 3588 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation 3589 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation 3590 */ 3591 enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc { 3592 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26, 3593 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52, 3594 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106, 3595 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242, 3596 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484, 3597 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996, 3598 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996, 3599 }; 3600 3601 /** 3602 * enum nl80211_eht_gi - EHT guard interval 3603 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec 3604 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec 3605 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec 3606 */ 3607 enum nl80211_eht_gi { 3608 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8, 3609 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6, 3610 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2, 3611 }; 3612 3613 /** 3614 * enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc - EHT RU allocation values 3615 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation 3616 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation 3617 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26: 52+26-tone RU allocation 3618 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation 3619 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26: 106+26 tone RU allocation 3620 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation 3621 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation 3622 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242: 484+242 tone RU allocation 3623 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation 3624 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484: 996+484 tone RU allocation 3625 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242: 996+484+242 tone RU allocation 3626 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation 3627 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484: 2x996+484 tone RU allocation 3628 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996: 3x996-tone RU allocation 3629 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484: 3x996+484 tone RU allocation 3630 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996: 4x996-tone RU allocation 3631 */ 3632 enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc { 3633 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26, 3634 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52, 3635 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26, 3636 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106, 3637 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26, 3638 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242, 3639 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484, 3640 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242, 3641 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996, 3642 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484, 3643 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242, 3644 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996, 3645 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484, 3646 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996, 3647 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484, 3648 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996, 3649 }; 3650 3651 /** 3652 * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information 3653 * 3654 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE 3655 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station. 3656 * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents 3657 * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value. 3658 * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported 3659 * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits 3660 * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included. 3661 * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall 3662 * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels. 3663 * 3664 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3665 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s) 3666 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8) 3667 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate 3668 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 3669 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s) 3670 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined 3671 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8) 3672 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8) 3673 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate 3674 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the 3675 * same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates 3676 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate 3677 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is 3678 * a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e. 3679 * half the base (20 MHz) rate 3680 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is 3681 * a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e. 3682 * a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate 3683 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11) 3684 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8) 3685 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier 3686 * (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi) 3687 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1) 3688 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then 3689 * non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc) 3690 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH: 320 MHz bitrate 3691 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS index (u8, 0-15) 3692 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS: EHT NSS value (u8, 1-8) 3693 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI: EHT guard interval identifier 3694 * (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_gi) 3695 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC: EHT RU allocation, if not present then 3696 * non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc) 3697 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS: S1G MCS index (u8, 0-10) 3698 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS: S1G NSS value (u8, 1-4) 3699 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH: 1 MHz S1G rate 3700 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH: 2 MHz S1G rate 3701 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH: 4 MHz S1G rate 3702 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH: 8 MHz S1G rate 3703 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH: 16 MHz S1G rate 3704 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3705 */ 3706 enum nl80211_rate_info { 3707 __NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID, 3708 NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE, 3709 NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS, 3710 NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH, 3711 NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI, 3712 NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32, 3713 NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS, 3714 NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS, 3715 NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH, 3716 NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH, 3717 NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH, 3718 NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH, 3719 NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH, 3720 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS, 3721 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS, 3722 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI, 3723 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM, 3724 NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC, 3725 NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH, 3726 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS, 3727 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS, 3728 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI, 3729 NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC, 3730 NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS, 3731 NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS, 3732 NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH, 3733 NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH, 3734 NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH, 3735 NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH, 3736 NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH, 3737 3738 /* keep last */ 3739 __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 3740 NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 3741 }; 3742 3743 /** 3744 * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA 3745 * 3746 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM 3747 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station. 3748 * 3749 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3750 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag) 3751 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 3752 * (flag) 3753 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 3754 * (flag) 3755 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8) 3756 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16) 3757 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined 3758 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use 3759 */ 3760 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param { 3761 __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID, 3762 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT, 3763 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE, 3764 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME, 3765 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD, 3766 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL, 3767 3768 /* keep last */ 3769 __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST, 3770 NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1 3771 }; 3772 3773 /** 3774 * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information 3775 * 3776 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO 3777 * when getting information about a station. 3778 * 3779 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3780 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs) 3781 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length) 3782 * (u32, from this station) 3783 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length) 3784 * (u32, to this station) 3785 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length) 3786 * (u64, from this station) 3787 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length) 3788 * (u64, to this station) 3789 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm) 3790 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute 3791 * containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info 3792 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs) 3793 * (u32, from this station) 3794 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs) 3795 * (u32, to this station) 3796 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station) 3797 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs) 3798 * (u32, to this station) 3799 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm) 3800 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID 3801 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID 3802 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station 3803 * (see %enum nl80211_plink_state) 3804 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested 3805 * attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE. 3806 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute 3807 * containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param 3808 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected 3809 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update. 3810 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32) 3811 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64) 3812 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode 3813 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode 3814 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards 3815 * non-peer STA 3816 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU 3817 * Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm) 3818 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average 3819 * Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL. 3820 * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the 3821 * 802.11 header (u32, kbps) 3822 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons 3823 * (u64) 3824 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64) 3825 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average 3826 * for beacons only (u8, dBm) 3827 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats) 3828 * This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the 3829 * TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames; 3830 * each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats 3831 * attributes carrying the actual values. 3832 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames 3833 * received from the station (u64, usec) 3834 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 3835 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm) 3836 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm) 3837 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs) 3838 * (u32, from this station) 3839 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received 3840 * with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include 3841 * some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter 3842 * might not be fully accurate. 3843 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a 3844 * mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1) 3845 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames 3846 * sent to the station (u64, usec) 3847 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16) 3848 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station 3849 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds) 3850 * of STA's association 3851 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a 3852 * authentication server (u8, 0 or 1) 3853 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal 3854 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute 3855 */ 3856 enum nl80211_sta_info { 3857 __NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID, 3858 NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME, 3859 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES, 3860 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES, 3861 NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID, 3862 NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID, 3863 NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE, 3864 NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL, 3865 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE, 3866 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS, 3867 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS, 3868 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES, 3869 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED, 3870 NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG, 3871 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE, 3872 NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM, 3873 NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME, 3874 NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS, 3875 NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS, 3876 NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET, 3877 NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM, 3878 NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM, 3879 NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM, 3880 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64, 3881 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64, 3882 NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL, 3883 NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG, 3884 NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT, 3885 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC, 3886 NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX, 3887 NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG, 3888 NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS, 3889 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION, 3890 NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD, 3891 NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL, 3892 NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG, 3893 NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS, 3894 NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT, 3895 NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE, 3896 NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION, 3897 NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT, 3898 NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC, 3899 NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME, 3900 NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS, 3901 3902 /* keep last */ 3903 __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 3904 NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 3905 }; 3906 3907 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */ 3908 #define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG 3909 3910 3911 /** 3912 * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes 3913 * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3914 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64) 3915 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or 3916 * attempted to transmit; u64) 3917 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for 3918 * transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64) 3919 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted 3920 * MSDUs (u64) 3921 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 3922 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute) 3923 * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here 3924 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here 3925 */ 3926 enum nl80211_tid_stats { 3927 __NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID, 3928 NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU, 3929 NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU, 3930 NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES, 3931 NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED, 3932 NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD, 3933 NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS, 3934 3935 /* keep last */ 3936 NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS, 3937 NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1 3938 }; 3939 3940 /** 3941 * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes 3942 * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 3943 * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here 3944 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged 3945 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently 3946 * backlogged 3947 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen 3948 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops 3949 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks 3950 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow 3951 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 3952 * (only for per-phy stats) 3953 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions 3954 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ 3955 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ 3956 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY 3957 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here 3958 */ 3959 enum nl80211_txq_stats { 3960 __NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID, 3961 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES, 3962 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS, 3963 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS, 3964 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS, 3965 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS, 3966 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT, 3967 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY, 3968 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS, 3969 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES, 3970 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS, 3971 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS, 3972 3973 /* keep last */ 3974 NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS, 3975 NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1 3976 }; 3977 3978 /** 3979 * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags 3980 * 3981 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active 3982 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running 3983 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN 3984 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set 3985 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded 3986 */ 3987 enum nl80211_mpath_flags { 3988 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<0, 3989 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING = 1<<1, 3990 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID = 1<<2, 3991 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED = 1<<3, 3992 NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED = 1<<4, 3993 }; 3994 3995 /** 3996 * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information 3997 * 3998 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting 3999 * information about a mesh path. 4000 * 4001 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4002 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination 4003 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number 4004 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path 4005 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now 4006 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in 4007 * &enum nl80211_mpath_flags; 4008 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec 4009 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries 4010 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination 4011 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination 4012 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number 4013 * currently defined 4014 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4015 */ 4016 enum nl80211_mpath_info { 4017 __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID, 4018 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN, 4019 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN, 4020 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC, 4021 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME, 4022 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS, 4023 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT, 4024 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES, 4025 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT, 4026 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE, 4027 4028 /* keep last */ 4029 __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 4030 NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 4031 }; 4032 4033 /** 4034 * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes 4035 * 4036 * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4037 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute 4038 * for each interface type that supports the band data 4039 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE 4040 * capabilities IE 4041 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE 4042 * capabilities IE 4043 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE 4044 * capabilities IE 4045 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as 4046 * defined in HE capabilities IE 4047 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16), 4048 * given for all 6 GHz band channels 4049 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS: vendor element capabilities that are 4050 * advertised on this band/for this iftype (binary) 4051 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC: EHT MAC capabilities as in EHT 4052 * capabilities element 4053 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY: EHT PHY capabilities as in EHT 4054 * capabilities element 4055 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET: EHT supported NSS/MCS as in EHT 4056 * capabilities element 4057 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE: EHT PPE thresholds information as 4058 * defined in EHT capabilities element 4059 * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4060 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined 4061 */ 4062 enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr { 4063 __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID, 4064 4065 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES, 4066 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC, 4067 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY, 4068 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET, 4069 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE, 4070 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA, 4071 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS, 4072 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC, 4073 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY, 4074 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET, 4075 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE, 4076 4077 /* keep last */ 4078 __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4079 NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4080 }; 4081 4082 /** 4083 * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes 4084 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4085 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band, 4086 * an array of nested frequency attributes 4087 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band, 4088 * an array of nested bitrate attributes 4089 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as 4090 * defined in 802.11n 4091 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE 4092 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n 4093 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n 4094 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as 4095 * defined in 802.11ac 4096 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE 4097 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using 4098 * attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr 4099 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz 4100 * channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions. 4101 * Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. 4102 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 4103 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. 4104 * Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13. 4105 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET: S1G capabilities, supported S1G-MCS and NSS 4106 * set subfield, as in the S1G information IE, 5 bytes 4107 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA: S1G capabilities information subfield as in the 4108 * S1G information IE, 10 bytes 4109 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined 4110 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4111 */ 4112 enum nl80211_band_attr { 4113 __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID, 4114 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS, 4115 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES, 4116 4117 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET, 4118 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA, 4119 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR, 4120 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY, 4121 4122 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET, 4123 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA, 4124 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA, 4125 4126 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS, 4127 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG, 4128 4129 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET, 4130 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA, 4131 4132 /* keep last */ 4133 __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4134 NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4135 }; 4136 4137 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA 4138 4139 /** 4140 * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule 4141 * 4142 * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4143 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot. 4144 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot. 4145 * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space. 4146 * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time. 4147 * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule. 4148 * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use. 4149 */ 4150 enum nl80211_wmm_rule { 4151 __NL80211_WMMR_INVALID, 4152 NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN, 4153 NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX, 4154 NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN, 4155 NL80211_WMMR_TXOP, 4156 4157 /* keep last */ 4158 __NL80211_WMMR_LAST, 4159 NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1 4160 }; 4161 4162 /** 4163 * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes 4164 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4165 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz 4166 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current 4167 * regulatory domain. 4168 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation 4169 * are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe 4170 * requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing. 4171 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory 4172 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4173 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm 4174 * (100 * dBm). 4175 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS 4176 * (enum nl80211_dfs_state) 4177 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in miliseconds for how long 4178 * this channel is in this DFS state. 4179 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this 4180 * channel as the control channel 4181 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this 4182 * channel as the control channel 4183 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel 4184 * as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible, 4185 * this includes 80+80 channels 4186 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel 4187 * using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels 4188 * isn't possible 4189 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds. 4190 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this 4191 * channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be 4192 * used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in 4193 * an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not 4194 * through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master 4195 * that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power. 4196 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this 4197 * channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on 4198 * the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz 4199 * band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS 4200 * off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be 4201 * done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under 4202 * the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS 4203 * off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and 4204 * radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e., 4205 * wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this 4206 * attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP). 4207 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed 4208 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4209 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed 4210 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4211 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations. 4212 * This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC. 4213 * (see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule) 4214 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel 4215 * in current regulatory domain. 4216 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz 4217 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed 4218 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4219 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed 4220 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4221 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed 4222 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4223 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed 4224 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4225 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed 4226 * on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4227 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ: any 320 MHz channel using this channel 4228 * as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible 4229 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not allowed on this channel 4230 * in current regulatory domain. 4231 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) that 4232 * is allowed on this channel in current regulatory domain. 4233 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number 4234 * currently defined 4235 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4236 * 4237 * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122 4238 * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed 4239 * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and 4240 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT. 4241 */ 4242 enum nl80211_frequency_attr { 4243 __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID, 4244 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ, 4245 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED, 4246 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR, 4247 __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS, 4248 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR, 4249 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER, 4250 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE, 4251 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME, 4252 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS, 4253 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS, 4254 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ, 4255 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ, 4256 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME, 4257 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY, 4258 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT, 4259 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ, 4260 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ, 4261 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM, 4262 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE, 4263 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET, 4264 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ, 4265 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ, 4266 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ, 4267 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ, 4268 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ, 4269 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ, 4270 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT, 4271 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD, 4272 4273 /* keep last */ 4274 __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4275 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4276 }; 4277 4278 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER 4279 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR 4280 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR 4281 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR 4282 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \ 4283 NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 4284 4285 /** 4286 * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes 4287 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4288 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps 4289 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported 4290 * in 2.4 GHz band. 4291 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number 4292 * currently defined 4293 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4294 */ 4295 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr { 4296 __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID, 4297 NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE, 4298 NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE, 4299 4300 /* keep last */ 4301 __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4302 NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4303 }; 4304 4305 /** 4306 * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request 4307 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world 4308 * regulatory domain. 4309 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the 4310 * regulatory domain. 4311 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the 4312 * wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in. 4313 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an 4314 * 802.11 country information element with regulatory information it 4315 * thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country 4316 * code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information 4317 * structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb. 4318 * If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should 4319 * be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation. 4320 */ 4321 enum nl80211_reg_initiator { 4322 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE, 4323 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER, 4324 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, 4325 NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE, 4326 }; 4327 4328 /** 4329 * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain 4330 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains 4331 * to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the 4332 * ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid. 4333 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory 4334 * domain. 4335 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom 4336 * driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide 4337 * and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested 4338 * them to be applied. 4339 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product 4340 * of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously 4341 * set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory 4342 * domain request to be processed. 4343 */ 4344 enum nl80211_reg_type { 4345 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY, 4346 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD, 4347 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD, 4348 NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION, 4349 }; 4350 4351 /** 4352 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes 4353 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4354 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional 4355 * considerations for a given frequency range. These are the 4356 * &enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags. 4357 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory 4358 * rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory 4359 * band edge. 4360 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule 4361 * in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory 4362 * band edge. 4363 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this 4364 * frequency range, in KHz. 4365 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain 4366 * for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi). 4367 * If you don't have one then don't send this. 4368 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for 4369 * a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm). 4370 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds. 4371 * If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used. 4372 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD: power spectral density (in dBm). 4373 * This could be negative. 4374 * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number 4375 * currently defined 4376 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4377 */ 4378 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr { 4379 __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID, 4380 NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, 4381 4382 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START, 4383 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END, 4384 NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW, 4385 4386 NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN, 4387 NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP, 4388 4389 NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME, 4390 4391 NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD, 4392 4393 /* keep last */ 4394 __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4395 NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4396 }; 4397 4398 /** 4399 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes 4400 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4401 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching, 4402 * only report BSS with matching SSID. 4403 * (This cannot be used together with BSSID.) 4404 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a 4405 * BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that 4406 * if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as 4407 * the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a 4408 * matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with 4409 * how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem, 4410 * the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this 4411 * attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute. 4412 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether 4413 * %NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or 4414 * relative to current bss's RSSI. 4415 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for 4416 * BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing 4417 * RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure 4418 * value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust. 4419 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching 4420 * (this cannot be used together with SSID). 4421 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Nested attribute that carries the 4422 * band specific minimum rssi thresholds for the bands defined in 4423 * enum nl80211_band. The minimum rssi threshold value(s32) specific to a 4424 * band shall be encapsulated in attribute with type value equals to one 4425 * of the NL80211_BAND_* defined in enum nl80211_band. For example, the 4426 * minimum rssi threshold value for 2.4GHZ band shall be encapsulated 4427 * within an attribute of type NL80211_BAND_2GHZ. And one or more of such 4428 * attributes will be nested within this attribute. 4429 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter 4430 * attribute number currently defined 4431 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4432 */ 4433 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr { 4434 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID, 4435 4436 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID, 4437 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI, 4438 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI, 4439 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST, 4440 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID, 4441 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI, 4442 4443 /* keep last */ 4444 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4445 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = 4446 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4447 }; 4448 4449 /* only for backward compatibility */ 4450 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID 4451 4452 /** 4453 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags 4454 * 4455 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed 4456 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed 4457 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed 4458 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed 4459 * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used 4460 * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links 4461 * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links 4462 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed, 4463 * this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require 4464 * beaconing. 4465 * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated 4466 * base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross 4467 * multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges. 4468 * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 4469 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation 4470 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation 4471 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed 4472 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed 4473 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed 4474 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ: 320MHz operation not allowed 4475 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT: EHT operation not allowed 4476 * @NL80211_RRF_PSD: Ruleset has power spectral density value 4477 */ 4478 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags { 4479 NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM = 1<<0, 4480 NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK = 1<<1, 4481 NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR = 1<<2, 4482 NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR = 1<<3, 4483 NL80211_RRF_DFS = 1<<4, 4484 NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY = 1<<5, 4485 NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY = 1<<6, 4486 NL80211_RRF_NO_IR = 1<<7, 4487 __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS = 1<<8, 4488 NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW = 1<<11, 4489 NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<12, 4490 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<13, 4491 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<14, 4492 NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ = 1<<15, 4493 NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ = 1<<16, 4494 NL80211_RRF_NO_HE = 1<<17, 4495 NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ = 1<<18, 4496 NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT = 1<<19, 4497 NL80211_RRF_PSD = 1<<20, 4498 }; 4499 4500 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN NL80211_RRF_NO_IR 4501 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS NL80211_RRF_NO_IR 4502 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR NL80211_RRF_NO_IR 4503 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40 (NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\ 4504 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS) 4505 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT 4506 4507 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */ 4508 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL (NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS) 4509 4510 /** 4511 * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions 4512 * 4513 * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified 4514 * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC 4515 * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI 4516 * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec 4517 */ 4518 enum nl80211_dfs_regions { 4519 NL80211_DFS_UNSET = 0, 4520 NL80211_DFS_FCC = 1, 4521 NL80211_DFS_ETSI = 2, 4522 NL80211_DFS_JP = 3, 4523 }; 4524 4525 /** 4526 * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint 4527 * 4528 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always 4529 * assumed if the attribute is not set. 4530 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular 4531 * base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work 4532 * properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints 4533 * by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature 4534 * capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will 4535 * ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device 4536 * present has been registered with the wireless core that 4537 * has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a 4538 * supported feature. 4539 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the 4540 * platform is operating in an indoor environment. 4541 */ 4542 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type { 4543 NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER = 0, 4544 NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1, 4545 NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR = 2, 4546 }; 4547 4548 /** 4549 * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information 4550 * 4551 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO 4552 * when getting information about a survey. 4553 * 4554 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 4555 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel 4556 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm) 4557 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 4558 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio 4559 * was turned on (on channel or globally) 4560 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary 4561 * channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect) 4562 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension 4563 * channel was sensed busy 4564 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent 4565 * receiving data (on channel or globally) 4566 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent 4567 * transmitting data (on channel or globally) 4568 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan 4569 * (on this channel or globally) 4570 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 4571 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent 4572 * receiving frames destined to the local BSS 4573 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number 4574 * currently defined 4575 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz 4576 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4577 */ 4578 enum nl80211_survey_info { 4579 __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID, 4580 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY, 4581 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE, 4582 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE, 4583 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME, 4584 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY, 4585 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY, 4586 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX, 4587 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX, 4588 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN, 4589 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD, 4590 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX, 4591 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET, 4592 4593 /* keep last */ 4594 __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST, 4595 NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1 4596 }; 4597 4598 /* keep old names for compatibility */ 4599 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME 4600 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY 4601 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY 4602 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX 4603 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX 4604 4605 /** 4606 * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags 4607 * 4608 * Monitor configuration flags. 4609 * 4610 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved 4611 * 4612 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 4613 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 4614 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 4615 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 4616 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing. 4617 * overrides all other flags. 4618 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address 4619 * and ACK incoming unicast packets. 4620 * 4621 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4622 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag 4623 */ 4624 enum nl80211_mntr_flags { 4625 __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 4626 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 4627 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 4628 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 4629 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 4630 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 4631 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 4632 4633 /* keep last */ 4634 __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST, 4635 NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1 4636 }; 4637 4638 /** 4639 * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes 4640 * 4641 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is 4642 * not known or has not been set yet. 4643 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is 4644 * in Awake state all the time. 4645 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will 4646 * alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for 4647 * neighbor's beacons. 4648 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will 4649 * alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up 4650 * for neighbor's beacons. 4651 * 4652 * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use 4653 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level 4654 */ 4655 4656 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode { 4657 NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN, 4658 NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE, 4659 NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP, 4660 NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP, 4661 4662 __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST, 4663 NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1 4664 }; 4665 4666 /** 4667 * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters 4668 * 4669 * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is 4670 * active. 4671 * 4672 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use 4673 * 4674 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in 4675 * millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message 4676 * 4677 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in 4678 * millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link 4679 * 4680 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in 4681 * millisecond units 4682 * 4683 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed 4684 * on this mesh interface 4685 * 4686 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link 4687 * open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a 4688 * mesh 4689 * 4690 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh 4691 * point. 4692 * 4693 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open 4694 * peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if 4695 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are 4696 * set. 4697 * 4698 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames 4699 * containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path 4700 * target) 4701 * 4702 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths 4703 * (in milliseconds) 4704 * 4705 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait 4706 * until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds) 4707 * 4708 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh 4709 * points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from 4710 * the root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 4711 * 4712 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in 4713 * TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 4714 * reference element 4715 * 4716 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs) 4717 * that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the 4718 * mesh 4719 * 4720 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not 4721 * 4722 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a 4723 * source mesh point for path selection elements. 4724 * 4725 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between 4726 * root announcements are transmitted. 4727 * 4728 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has 4729 * access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. This is done via Root 4730 * Announcement frames. 4731 * 4732 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in 4733 * TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a 4734 * PERR element. 4735 * 4736 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding 4737 * or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 4738 * 4739 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the 4740 * threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish 4741 * a peer link. 4742 * 4743 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors 4744 * to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 4745 * (see 11C.12.2.2) 4746 * 4747 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode. 4748 * 4749 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute 4750 * 4751 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for 4752 * which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding 4753 * information to the root mesh STA to be valid. 4754 * 4755 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between 4756 * proactive PREQs are transmitted. 4757 * 4758 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time 4759 * (in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame 4760 * containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 4761 * 4762 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links. 4763 * type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32) 4764 * 4765 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs) 4766 * 4767 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've 4768 * established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then 4769 * remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable 4770 * the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes. 4771 * 4772 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA 4773 * will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation 4774 * field. If left unset then the mesh formation field will only 4775 * advertise such if there is an active root mesh path. 4776 * 4777 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. 4778 * PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that 4779 * this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be 4780 * better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable 4781 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. 4782 * 4783 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA 4784 * will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server 4785 * in the mesh formation field. 4786 * 4787 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use 4788 */ 4789 enum nl80211_meshconf_params { 4790 __NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID, 4791 NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT, 4792 NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT, 4793 NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT, 4794 NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS, 4795 NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES, 4796 NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL, 4797 NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS, 4798 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES, 4799 NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME, 4800 NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT, 4801 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT, 4802 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL, 4803 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME, 4804 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE, 4805 NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL, 4806 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL, 4807 NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS, 4808 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL, 4809 NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING, 4810 NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD, 4811 NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR, 4812 NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE, 4813 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT, 4814 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL, 4815 NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL, 4816 NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE, 4817 NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW, 4818 NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT, 4819 NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE, 4820 NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN, 4821 NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS, 4822 4823 /* keep last */ 4824 __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4825 NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4826 }; 4827 4828 /** 4829 * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters 4830 * 4831 * Mesh setup parameters. These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be 4832 * changed while the mesh is active. 4833 * 4834 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use 4835 * 4836 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a 4837 * vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the 4838 * default HWMP. 4839 * 4840 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a 4841 * vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime 4842 * metric. 4843 * 4844 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a 4845 * robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element 4846 * that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and 4847 * metrics in use. 4848 * 4849 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication 4850 * daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates. 4851 * 4852 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication 4853 * daemon will be securing peer link frames. AMPE is a secured version of 4854 * Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of 4855 * a userspace daemon. When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer 4856 * management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE 4857 * functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and 4858 * key management). When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can 4859 * autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a 4860 * userspace daemon. 4861 * 4862 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a 4863 * vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default 4864 * neighbor offset synchronization 4865 * 4866 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will 4867 * implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state. 4868 * 4869 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication 4870 * method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE). 4871 * Default is no authentication method required. 4872 * 4873 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number 4874 * 4875 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use 4876 */ 4877 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params { 4878 __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID, 4879 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL, 4880 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC, 4881 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE, 4882 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH, 4883 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, 4884 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC, 4885 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM, 4886 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL, 4887 4888 /* keep last */ 4889 __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4890 NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4891 }; 4892 4893 /** 4894 * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes 4895 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved 4896 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*) 4897 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning 4898 * disabled 4899 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 4900 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 4901 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 4902 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 4903 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 4904 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal 4905 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number 4906 */ 4907 enum nl80211_txq_attr { 4908 __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID, 4909 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC, 4910 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP, 4911 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN, 4912 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX, 4913 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS, 4914 4915 /* keep last */ 4916 __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 4917 NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 4918 }; 4919 4920 enum nl80211_ac { 4921 NL80211_AC_VO, 4922 NL80211_AC_VI, 4923 NL80211_AC_BE, 4924 NL80211_AC_BK, 4925 NL80211_NUM_ACS 4926 }; 4927 4928 /* backward compat */ 4929 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC 4930 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO NL80211_AC_VO 4931 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI NL80211_AC_VI 4932 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE NL80211_AC_BE 4933 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK NL80211_AC_BK 4934 4935 /** 4936 * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type 4937 * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel 4938 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel 4939 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel 4940 * below the control channel 4941 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel 4942 * above the control channel 4943 */ 4944 enum nl80211_channel_type { 4945 NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT, 4946 NL80211_CHAN_HT20, 4947 NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS, 4948 NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS 4949 }; 4950 4951 /** 4952 * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode 4953 * 4954 * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default) 4955 * Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately 4956 * 4957 * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the 4958 * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: 4959 * 4960 * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: 4961 * Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet 4962 * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: 4963 * The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes 4964 * the preferred Tx key for the station. 4965 */ 4966 enum nl80211_key_mode { 4967 NL80211_KEY_RX_TX, 4968 NL80211_KEY_NO_TX, 4969 NL80211_KEY_SET_TX 4970 }; 4971 4972 /** 4973 * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions 4974 * 4975 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH 4976 * attribute. 4977 * 4978 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel 4979 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel 4980 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4981 * attribute must be provided as well 4982 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4983 * attribute must be provided as well 4984 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4985 * and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well 4986 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4987 * attribute must be provided as well 4988 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel 4989 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel 4990 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel 4991 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel 4992 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel 4993 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel 4994 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel 4995 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320: 320 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1 4996 * attribute must be provided as well 4997 */ 4998 enum nl80211_chan_width { 4999 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT, 5000 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 5001 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40, 5002 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80, 5003 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80, 5004 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160, 5005 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5, 5006 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10, 5007 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1, 5008 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2, 5009 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4, 5010 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8, 5011 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16, 5012 NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320, 5013 }; 5014 5015 /** 5016 * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS 5017 * 5018 * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute. 5019 * 5020 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible 5021 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide 5022 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide 5023 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide 5024 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide 5025 */ 5026 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width { 5027 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 5028 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10, 5029 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5, 5030 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1, 5031 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2, 5032 }; 5033 5034 /** 5035 * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS 5036 * 5037 * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid 5038 * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets) 5039 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32) 5040 * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64) 5041 * (if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be 5042 * from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon 5043 * that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from) 5044 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16) 5045 * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16) 5046 * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the 5047 * raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin); 5048 * if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is 5049 * different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise 5050 * they are from a Beacon frame. 5051 * However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these 5052 * IEs may be from either frame subtype. 5053 * If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the 5054 * data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics. 5055 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon 5056 * in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32) 5057 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon 5058 * in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8) 5059 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used" 5060 * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms 5061 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information 5062 * elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has 5063 * yet been received 5064 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel 5065 * (u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width) - No longer used! 5066 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64) 5067 * (not present if no beacon frame has been received yet) 5068 * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and 5069 * @NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute) 5070 * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry 5071 * was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be 5072 * accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds) 5073 * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment 5074 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first 5075 * octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for 5076 * this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by 5077 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64). 5078 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF 5079 * is set. 5080 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update. 5081 * Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm), 5082 * using the nesting index as the antenna number. 5083 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz 5084 * @NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID: MLO link ID of the BSS (u8). 5085 * @NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR: MLD address of this BSS if connected to it. 5086 * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal 5087 * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute 5088 */ 5089 enum nl80211_bss { 5090 __NL80211_BSS_INVALID, 5091 NL80211_BSS_BSSID, 5092 NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY, 5093 NL80211_BSS_TSF, 5094 NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL, 5095 NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY, 5096 NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS, 5097 NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM, 5098 NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC, 5099 NL80211_BSS_STATUS, 5100 NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO, 5101 NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES, 5102 NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH, 5103 NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF, 5104 NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA, 5105 NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME, 5106 NL80211_BSS_PAD, 5107 NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF, 5108 NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID, 5109 NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL, 5110 NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET, 5111 NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID, 5112 NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR, 5113 5114 /* keep last */ 5115 __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST, 5116 NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1 5117 }; 5118 5119 /** 5120 * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status" 5121 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS. 5122 * Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer 5123 * keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with 5124 * a given BSS. 5125 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS. 5126 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS. 5127 * 5128 * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which 5129 * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS. 5130 */ 5131 enum nl80211_bss_status { 5132 NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED, 5133 NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED, 5134 NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED, 5135 }; 5136 5137 /** 5138 * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType 5139 * 5140 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication 5141 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only) 5142 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r) 5143 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP) 5144 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals 5145 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key 5146 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS 5147 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key 5148 * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal 5149 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm 5150 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by 5151 * trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out 5152 * the attribute for this on CONNECT commands. 5153 */ 5154 enum nl80211_auth_type { 5155 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM, 5156 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY, 5157 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT, 5158 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP, 5159 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE, 5160 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK, 5161 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS, 5162 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK, 5163 5164 /* keep last */ 5165 __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM, 5166 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1, 5167 NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC 5168 }; 5169 5170 /** 5171 * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type 5172 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key 5173 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key 5174 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS) 5175 * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types 5176 */ 5177 enum nl80211_key_type { 5178 NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP, 5179 NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE, 5180 NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY, 5181 5182 NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES 5183 }; 5184 5185 /** 5186 * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state 5187 * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used 5188 * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required 5189 * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional 5190 */ 5191 enum nl80211_mfp { 5192 NL80211_MFP_NO, 5193 NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED, 5194 NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL, 5195 }; 5196 5197 enum nl80211_wpa_versions { 5198 NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0, 5199 NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1, 5200 NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2, 5201 }; 5202 5203 /** 5204 * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types 5205 * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid 5206 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default 5207 * unicast key 5208 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default 5209 * multicast key 5210 * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types 5211 */ 5212 enum nl80211_key_default_types { 5213 __NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID, 5214 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST, 5215 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST, 5216 5217 NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES 5218 }; 5219 5220 /** 5221 * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes 5222 * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid 5223 * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of 5224 * 16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC 5225 * keys 5226 * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3) 5227 * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11 5228 * section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04) 5229 * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and 5230 * CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian 5231 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key 5232 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key 5233 * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not 5234 * specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was 5235 * given with the command using the key or not (u32) 5236 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags 5237 * attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as. 5238 * See &enum nl80211_key_default_types. 5239 * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode. 5240 * Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX. 5241 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key 5242 * 5243 * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal 5244 * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute 5245 */ 5246 enum nl80211_key_attributes { 5247 __NL80211_KEY_INVALID, 5248 NL80211_KEY_DATA, 5249 NL80211_KEY_IDX, 5250 NL80211_KEY_CIPHER, 5251 NL80211_KEY_SEQ, 5252 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT, 5253 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, 5254 NL80211_KEY_TYPE, 5255 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES, 5256 NL80211_KEY_MODE, 5257 NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON, 5258 5259 /* keep last */ 5260 __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST, 5261 NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1 5262 }; 5263 5264 /** 5265 * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes 5266 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid 5267 * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection 5268 * in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with 5269 * 1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most 5270 * %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array). 5271 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection 5272 * in an array of MCS numbers. 5273 * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection, 5274 * see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht 5275 * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi 5276 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection, 5277 * see &struct nl80211_txrate_he 5278 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us. 5279 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF. 5280 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal 5281 * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute 5282 */ 5283 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes { 5284 __NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID, 5285 NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY, 5286 NL80211_TXRATE_HT, 5287 NL80211_TXRATE_VHT, 5288 NL80211_TXRATE_GI, 5289 NL80211_TXRATE_HE, 5290 NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI, 5291 NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF, 5292 5293 /* keep last */ 5294 __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST, 5295 NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1 5296 }; 5297 5298 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT 5299 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX 8 5300 5301 /** 5302 * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap 5303 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.) 5304 */ 5305 struct nl80211_txrate_vht { 5306 __u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 5307 }; 5308 5309 #define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX 8 5310 /** 5311 * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap 5312 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.) 5313 */ 5314 struct nl80211_txrate_he { 5315 __u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; 5316 }; 5317 5318 enum nl80211_txrate_gi { 5319 NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI, 5320 NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI, 5321 NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI, 5322 }; 5323 5324 /** 5325 * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band 5326 * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band 5327 * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz) 5328 * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz) 5329 * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz) 5330 * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs 5331 * @NL80211_BAND_LC: light communication band (placeholder) 5332 * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace 5333 * since newer kernel versions may support more bands 5334 */ 5335 enum nl80211_band { 5336 NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, 5337 NL80211_BAND_5GHZ, 5338 NL80211_BAND_60GHZ, 5339 NL80211_BAND_6GHZ, 5340 NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ, 5341 NL80211_BAND_LC, 5342 5343 NUM_NL80211_BANDS, 5344 }; 5345 5346 /** 5347 * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state 5348 * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled 5349 * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled 5350 */ 5351 enum nl80211_ps_state { 5352 NL80211_PS_DISABLED, 5353 NL80211_PS_ENABLED, 5354 }; 5355 5356 /** 5357 * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes 5358 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid 5359 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies 5360 * the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero 5361 * to disable. Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is 5362 * set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of 5363 * threshold values in dBm. Events will be sent when the RSSI value 5364 * crosses any of the thresholds. 5365 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies 5366 * the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a 5367 * new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation). 5368 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event 5369 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many 5370 * consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer 5371 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures 5372 * during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an 5373 * %NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and 5374 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated. 5375 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given 5376 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is 5377 * checked. 5378 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic 5379 * interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and 5380 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an 5381 * %NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting. 5382 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon 5383 * loss event 5384 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the 5385 * RSSI threshold event. 5386 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal 5387 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute 5388 */ 5389 enum nl80211_attr_cqm { 5390 __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID, 5391 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD, 5392 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST, 5393 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT, 5394 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT, 5395 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE, 5396 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS, 5397 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL, 5398 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT, 5399 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL, 5400 5401 /* keep last */ 5402 __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST, 5403 NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1 5404 }; 5405 5406 /** 5407 * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event 5408 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the 5409 * configured threshold 5410 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the 5411 * configured threshold 5412 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent) 5413 */ 5414 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event { 5415 NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW, 5416 NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH, 5417 NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT, 5418 }; 5419 5420 5421 /** 5422 * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment 5423 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power 5424 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter 5425 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter 5426 */ 5427 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting { 5428 NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC, 5429 NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED, 5430 NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED, 5431 }; 5432 5433 /** 5434 * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state 5435 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID 5436 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID 5437 */ 5438 enum nl80211_tid_config { 5439 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE, 5440 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE, 5441 }; 5442 5443 /* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type 5444 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate 5445 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter 5446 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter 5447 */ 5448 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting { 5449 NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC, 5450 NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED, 5451 NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED, 5452 }; 5453 5454 /* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration. 5455 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values 5456 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported 5457 * for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic 5458 * (%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE). 5459 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but 5460 * per peer instead. 5461 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribue, if set indicates 5462 * that the new configuration overrides all previous peer 5463 * configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations 5464 * should be left untouched. 5465 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7) 5466 * Its type is u16. 5467 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID. 5468 * specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config. 5469 * Its type is u8. 5470 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame 5471 * transmission, user-space sets this configuration in 5472 * &NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and 5473 * the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on 5474 * output in wiphy capabilities. 5475 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame 5476 * transmission, user-space sets this configuration in 5477 * &NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and 5478 * the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on 5479 * output in wiphy capabilities. 5480 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation 5481 * for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. 5482 * Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config. 5483 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs 5484 * specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using 5485 * the values from &nl80211_tid_config. 5486 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation 5487 * for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. 5488 * Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config. 5489 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful 5490 * to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used 5491 * for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using 5492 * the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting. 5493 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied 5494 * with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES. 5495 * configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected 5496 * station. 5497 */ 5498 enum nl80211_tid_config_attr { 5499 __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID, 5500 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD, 5501 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP, 5502 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP, 5503 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE, 5504 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, 5505 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK, 5506 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT, 5507 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG, 5508 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL, 5509 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL, 5510 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL, 5511 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE, 5512 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE, 5513 5514 /* keep last */ 5515 __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 5516 NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 5517 }; 5518 5519 /** 5520 * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute 5521 * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute 5522 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has 5523 * a zero bit are ignored 5524 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have 5525 * a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds 5526 * to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are 5527 * in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern 5528 * corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask. 5529 * For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where 5530 * xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of 5531 * twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01". 5532 * Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not 5533 * 802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked 5534 * first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched. 5535 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after 5536 * these fixed number of bytes of received packet 5537 * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes 5538 * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number 5539 */ 5540 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr { 5541 __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID, 5542 NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK, 5543 NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN, 5544 NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET, 5545 5546 NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT, 5547 MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1, 5548 }; 5549 5550 /** 5551 * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information 5552 * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported 5553 * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern 5554 * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern 5555 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 5556 * 5557 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when 5558 * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in 5559 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of 5560 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given 5561 * by the kernel to userspace. 5562 */ 5563 struct nl80211_pattern_support { 5564 __u32 max_patterns; 5565 __u32 min_pattern_len; 5566 __u32 max_pattern_len; 5567 __u32 max_pkt_offset; 5568 } __attribute__((packed)); 5569 5570 /* only for backward compatibility */ 5571 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID 5572 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK 5573 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN 5574 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET 5575 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT 5576 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT 5577 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support 5578 5579 /** 5580 * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions 5581 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 5582 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put 5583 * the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have 5584 * support for low-power operation already (flag) 5585 * Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if 5586 * any others are even supported by the device. 5587 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect 5588 * is detected is implementation-specific (flag) 5589 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed 5590 * by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag) 5591 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns 5592 * which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute 5593 * defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern. 5594 * Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with 5595 * each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is 5596 * done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the 5597 * pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU. 5598 * 5599 * In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute 5600 * carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support. 5601 * 5602 * When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based 5603 * index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed 5604 * to the kernel when configuring. 5605 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be 5606 * used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported 5607 * by the device (flag) 5608 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if 5609 * done by the device) (flag) 5610 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request 5611 * packet (flag) 5612 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag) 5613 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released 5614 * (on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag) 5615 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains 5616 * the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame 5617 * may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN 5618 * attribute contains the original length. 5619 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11 5620 * packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211 5621 * attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere. 5622 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the 5623 * 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may 5624 * be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute 5625 * contains the original length. 5626 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3 5627 * packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023 5628 * attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere. 5629 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section 5630 * "TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute 5631 * containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive 5632 * the TCP connection. 5633 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the 5634 * wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection 5635 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the 5636 * TCP connection was lost or failed to be established 5637 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only, 5638 * the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the 5639 * service 5640 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network 5641 * is detected. This is a nested attribute that contains the 5642 * same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN. It 5643 * specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the 5644 * channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan 5645 * results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets). This 5646 * attribute is also sent in a response to 5647 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets 5648 * supported by the driver (u32). 5649 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute 5650 * containing an array with information about what triggered the 5651 * wake up. If no elements are present in the array, it means 5652 * that the information is not available. If more than one 5653 * element is present, it means that more than one match 5654 * occurred. 5655 * Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains 5656 * one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional 5657 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute. At least one of 5658 * these attributes must be present. If 5659 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one 5660 * frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one 5661 * channel. 5662 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers 5663 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number 5664 * 5665 * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and 5666 * to report the wakeup reason(s). 5667 */ 5668 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers { 5669 __NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID, 5670 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY, 5671 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT, 5672 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT, 5673 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN, 5674 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED, 5675 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE, 5676 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST, 5677 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE, 5678 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE, 5679 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211, 5680 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN, 5681 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023, 5682 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN, 5683 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION, 5684 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH, 5685 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST, 5686 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS, 5687 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT, 5688 NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS, 5689 5690 /* keep last */ 5691 NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG, 5692 MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1 5693 }; 5694 5695 /** 5696 * DOC: TCP connection wakeup 5697 * 5698 * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a 5699 * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If 5700 * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given 5701 * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data 5702 * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK. 5703 * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence 5704 * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also 5705 * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive 5706 * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc. 5707 * 5708 * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the 5709 * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern 5710 * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the 5711 * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is 5712 * also woken up. 5713 * 5714 * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP 5715 * response packets might not go through correctly. 5716 */ 5717 5718 /** 5719 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence 5720 * @start: starting value 5721 * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet 5722 * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4 5723 * 5724 * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the 5725 * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet 5726 * in little endian. 5727 */ 5728 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq { 5729 __u32 start, offset, len; 5730 }; 5731 5732 /** 5733 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config 5734 * @offset: offset of token in packet 5735 * @len: length of each token 5736 * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must 5737 * be a multiple of @len for this to make sense 5738 */ 5739 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token { 5740 __u32 offset, len; 5741 __u8 token_stream[]; 5742 }; 5743 5744 /** 5745 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features 5746 * @min_len: minimum token length 5747 * @max_len: maximum token length 5748 * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream) 5749 */ 5750 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature { 5751 __u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize; 5752 }; 5753 5754 /** 5755 * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters 5756 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 5757 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order) 5758 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address 5759 * (in network byte order) 5760 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because 5761 * route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend, 5762 * and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it 5763 * might require ARP querying. 5764 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a 5765 * socket and port will be allocated 5766 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16) 5767 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte. 5768 * For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length 5769 * of the data payload. 5770 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration 5771 * (if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature 5772 * advertising it is just a flag 5773 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration, 5774 * see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see 5775 * &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature. 5776 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum 5777 * interval in feature advertising (u32) 5778 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a 5779 * u32 attribute holding the maximum length 5780 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for 5781 * feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK 5782 * but on the TCP payload only. 5783 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes 5784 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number 5785 */ 5786 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs { 5787 __NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID, 5788 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4, 5789 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4, 5790 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC, 5791 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT, 5792 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT, 5793 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD, 5794 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ, 5795 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN, 5796 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL, 5797 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD, 5798 NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK, 5799 5800 /* keep last */ 5801 NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP, 5802 MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1 5803 }; 5804 5805 /** 5806 * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information 5807 * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported 5808 * @pat: packet pattern support information 5809 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 5810 * 5811 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the 5812 * capability information given by the kernel to userspace. 5813 */ 5814 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support { 5815 __u32 max_rules; 5816 struct nl80211_pattern_support pat; 5817 __u32 max_delay; 5818 } __attribute__((packed)); 5819 5820 /** 5821 * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute 5822 * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute 5823 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing 5824 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence, 5825 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 5826 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched 5827 * after these fixed number of bytes of received packet 5828 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes 5829 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number 5830 */ 5831 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule { 5832 __NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID, 5833 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY, 5834 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION, 5835 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN, 5836 5837 /* keep last */ 5838 NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE, 5839 NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1 5840 }; 5841 5842 /** 5843 * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions 5844 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalaesce Rx packets when patterns 5845 * in a rule are matched. 5846 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns 5847 * in a rule are not matched. 5848 */ 5849 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition { 5850 NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH, 5851 NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH 5852 }; 5853 5854 /** 5855 * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes 5856 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved) 5857 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that 5858 * can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32) 5859 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a 5860 * flag attribute for each interface type in this set 5861 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes 5862 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number 5863 */ 5864 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs { 5865 NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC, 5866 NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX, 5867 NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES, 5868 5869 /* keep last */ 5870 NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT, 5871 MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1 5872 }; 5873 5874 /** 5875 * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes 5876 * 5877 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved) 5878 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits 5879 * for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs. 5880 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of 5881 * interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't 5882 * apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed 5883 * in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE. 5884 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that 5885 * beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for 5886 * infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt 5887 * the infrastructure network's beacon interval. 5888 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many 5889 * different channels may be used within this group. 5890 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap 5891 * of supported channel widths for radar detection. 5892 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap 5893 * of supported regulatory regions for radar detection. 5894 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of 5895 * different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations 5896 * in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical). 5897 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes 5898 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number 5899 * 5900 * Examples: 5901 * limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2 5902 * => allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs 5903 * 5904 * numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8, 5905 * => allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd 5906 * 5907 * numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2 5908 * => allows two STAs on the same or on different channels 5909 * 5910 * numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4 5911 * => allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces 5912 * 5913 * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained 5914 * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate 5915 * that any of these groups must match. 5916 * 5917 * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here, 5918 * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always 5919 * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid 5920 * interface type, the following group always exists: 5921 * numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1 5922 */ 5923 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs { 5924 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC, 5925 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS, 5926 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM, 5927 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH, 5928 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS, 5929 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS, 5930 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS, 5931 NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD, 5932 5933 /* keep last */ 5934 NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB, 5935 MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1 5936 }; 5937 5938 5939 /** 5940 * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine 5941 * 5942 * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit 5943 * state of non existent mesh peer links 5944 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to 5945 * this mesh peer 5946 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received 5947 * from this mesh peer 5948 * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been 5949 * received from this mesh peer 5950 * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established 5951 * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled 5952 * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh 5953 * plink are discarded, except for authentication frames 5954 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states 5955 * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states 5956 */ 5957 enum nl80211_plink_state { 5958 NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN, 5959 NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT, 5960 NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD, 5961 NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD, 5962 NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB, 5963 NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING, 5964 NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED, 5965 5966 /* keep last */ 5967 NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES, 5968 MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1 5969 }; 5970 5971 /** 5972 * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers 5973 * 5974 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action 5975 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment 5976 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer 5977 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions 5978 */ 5979 enum plink_actions { 5980 NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION, 5981 NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN, 5982 NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK, 5983 5984 NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS, 5985 }; 5986 5987 5988 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN 16 5989 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN 16 5990 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN 24 5991 #define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN 32 5992 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN_32 32 5993 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN 8 5994 5995 /** 5996 * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload 5997 * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 5998 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary) 5999 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary) 6000 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary) 6001 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type) 6002 * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal) 6003 * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal) 6004 */ 6005 enum nl80211_rekey_data { 6006 __NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID, 6007 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK, 6008 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK, 6009 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR, 6010 NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM, 6011 6012 /* keep last */ 6013 NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA, 6014 MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1 6015 }; 6016 6017 /** 6018 * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID 6019 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in 6020 * Beacon frames) 6021 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element 6022 * in Beacon frames 6023 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID 6024 * element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID 6025 */ 6026 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid { 6027 NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE, 6028 NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN, 6029 NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS 6030 }; 6031 6032 /** 6033 * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes 6034 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute 6035 * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format 6036 * is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field. 6037 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same 6038 * as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down). 6039 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal 6040 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute 6041 */ 6042 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr { 6043 __NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID, 6044 NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES, 6045 NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP, 6046 6047 /* keep last */ 6048 __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST, 6049 NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1 6050 }; 6051 6052 /** 6053 * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates 6054 * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes 6055 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher 6056 * priority) 6057 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets) 6058 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag) 6059 * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes 6060 * (internal) 6061 * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute 6062 * (internal) 6063 */ 6064 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr { 6065 __NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID, 6066 NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX, 6067 NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID, 6068 NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH, 6069 6070 /* keep last */ 6071 NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE, 6072 MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1 6073 }; 6074 6075 /** 6076 * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION 6077 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request 6078 * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link 6079 * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established 6080 * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link 6081 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link 6082 */ 6083 enum nl80211_tdls_operation { 6084 NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ, 6085 NL80211_TDLS_SETUP, 6086 NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN, 6087 NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK, 6088 NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK, 6089 }; 6090 6091 /** 6092 * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features 6093 * @NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD: SA Query procedures offloaded to driver 6094 * when user space indicates support for SA Query procedures offload during 6095 * "start ap" with %NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT. 6096 */ 6097 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features { 6098 NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD = 1 << 0, 6099 }; 6100 6101 /** 6102 * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features 6103 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back 6104 * TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the 6105 * socket option. 6106 * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates. 6107 * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up 6108 * the connected inactive stations in AP mode. 6109 * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested 6110 * to work properly to support receiving regulatory hints from 6111 * cellular base stations. 6112 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only 6113 * here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility) 6114 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of 6115 * equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station 6116 * mode 6117 * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan 6118 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported 6119 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif 6120 * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting 6121 * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform 6122 * OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only 6123 * for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied. 6124 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window 6125 * setting 6126 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic 6127 * powersave 6128 * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state 6129 * transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver 6130 * doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding 6131 * stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated 6132 * state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag 6133 * they should be added before even sending the authentication reply 6134 * and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized 6135 * states using station flags. 6136 * Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add 6137 * stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated 6138 * stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask. 6139 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits 6140 * (HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set 6141 * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh 6142 * Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for 6143 * beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is 6144 * still generated by the driver. 6145 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor 6146 * interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor 6147 * interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming 6148 * unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed. 6149 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic 6150 * channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the 6151 * lifetime of a BSS. 6152 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter 6153 * Set IE to probe requests. 6154 * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE 6155 * to probe requests. 6156 * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period 6157 * requests sent to it by an AP. 6158 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the 6159 * current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum 6160 * management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link 6161 * Measurement Report action frame. 6162 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout 6163 * estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used 6164 * to enable dynack. 6165 * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial 6166 * multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain 6167 * even on HT connections that should be using more chains. 6168 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial 6169 * multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain 6170 * and then wake the rest up as required after, for example, 6171 * rts/cts handshake. 6172 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM 6173 * TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS 6174 * command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it 6175 * needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things. 6176 * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring 6177 * the vif's MAC address upon creation. 6178 * See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h). 6179 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when 6180 * operating as a TDLS peer. 6181 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a 6182 * random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the 6183 * %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC 6184 * address mask/value will be used. 6185 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports 6186 * using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled 6187 * scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may 6188 * be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used. 6189 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a 6190 * random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e. 6191 * scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may 6192 * be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used. 6193 */ 6194 enum nl80211_feature_flags { 6195 NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS = 1 << 0, 6196 NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS = 1 << 1, 6197 NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER = 1 << 2, 6198 NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS = 1 << 3, 6199 NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL = 1 << 4, 6200 NL80211_FEATURE_SAE = 1 << 5, 6201 NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN = 1 << 6, 6202 NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH = 1 << 7, 6203 NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN = 1 << 8, 6204 NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER = 1 << 9, 6205 NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN = 1 << 10, 6206 NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN = 1 << 11, 6207 NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS = 1 << 12, 6208 /* bit 13 is reserved */ 6209 NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS = 1 << 14, 6210 NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE = 1 << 15, 6211 NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM = 1 << 16, 6212 NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR = 1 << 17, 6213 NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE = 1 << 18, 6214 NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES = 1 << 19, 6215 NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES = 1 << 20, 6216 NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET = 1 << 21, 6217 NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION = 1 << 22, 6218 NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION = 1 << 23, 6219 NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS = 1 << 24, 6220 NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS = 1 << 25, 6221 NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION = 1 << 26, 6222 NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE = 1 << 27, 6223 NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = 1 << 28, 6224 NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR = 1 << 29, 6225 NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR = 1 << 30, 6226 NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR = 1U << 31, 6227 }; 6228 6229 /** 6230 * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features. 6231 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates. 6232 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can 6233 * request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with 6234 * %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set 6235 * the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if 6236 * NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertized. 6237 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air 6238 * sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from 6239 * certain groups which can be configured by the 6240 * %NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute, 6241 * or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the 6242 * %NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute. 6243 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual 6244 * time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of 6245 * the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to 6246 * (if available). 6247 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the 6248 * time the last beacon/probe was received. For a non MLO connection, the 6249 * time is the TSF of the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is 6250 * connected to (if available). For an MLO connection, the time is the TSF 6251 * of the BSS corresponding with link ID specified in the scan request (if 6252 * specified). 6253 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of 6254 * channel dwell time. 6255 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate 6256 * configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non HT/VHT) rate. 6257 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate 6258 * configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates. 6259 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate 6260 * configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates. 6261 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup 6262 * with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode. 6263 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA 6264 * in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated. 6265 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports 6266 * randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated. 6267 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan 6268 * for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS 6269 * (%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI). 6270 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the 6271 * %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more 6272 * RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold. 6273 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key 6274 * authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. 6275 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way 6276 * handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect 6277 * and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported. 6278 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way 6279 * handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host 6280 * and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not 6281 * be supported. 6282 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding 6283 * the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the 6284 * actual dwell time. 6285 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe 6286 * response 6287 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending 6288 * the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps. 6289 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports 6290 * probe request tx deferral and suppression 6291 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL 6292 * value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP. 6293 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan. 6294 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan. 6295 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan. 6296 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions. 6297 * Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself, 6298 * informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event, 6299 * channel change triggered by radar detection event. 6300 * No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to 6301 * "radar detected" event. 6302 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and 6303 * receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice. 6304 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports 6305 * (average) ACK signal strength reporting. 6306 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate 6307 * TXQs. 6308 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the 6309 * SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN. 6310 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data 6311 * except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested 6312 * by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag. 6313 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine 6314 * timing measurement responder role. 6315 * 6316 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are 6317 * able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys 6318 * if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or 6319 * freeze the connection. 6320 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for 6321 * Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016. 6322 * 6323 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime 6324 * fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness 6325 * scheduling. 6326 * 6327 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching 6328 * (set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode. 6329 * 6330 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Driver supports 6331 * filtering of sched scan results using band specific RSSI thresholds. 6332 * 6333 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power 6334 * to a station. 6335 * 6336 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in 6337 * station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command). 6338 * 6339 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev 6340 * with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using 6341 * vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case. 6342 * 6343 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL) 6344 * feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission 6345 * time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware. 6346 * 6347 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection 6348 * and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7. 6349 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon 6350 * protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons. 6351 * 6352 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the 6353 * forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then 6354 * handled as ordinary data frames. 6355 * 6356 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames 6357 * 6358 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations 6359 * in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state. 6360 * 6361 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations 6362 * are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly. 6363 * 6364 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and 6365 * reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to 6366 * report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be 6367 * included in the scan request. 6368 * 6369 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver 6370 * can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations. 6371 * 6372 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating 6373 * Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes. 6374 * 6375 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way 6376 * handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP 6377 * command). 6378 * 6379 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication 6380 * in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command). 6381 * 6382 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery 6383 * frames transmission 6384 * 6385 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports 6386 * unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission 6387 * 6388 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate 6389 * configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates. 6390 * 6391 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement 6392 * exchange protocol. 6393 * 6394 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement 6395 * exchange protocol. 6396 * 6397 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management 6398 * frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the 6399 * negotiation and range measurement procedure. 6400 * 6401 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR: The driver supports BSS color collision 6402 * detection and change announcemnts. 6403 * 6404 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD: Driver running in AP mode supports 6405 * FILS encryption and decryption for (Re)Association Request and Response 6406 * frames. Userspace has to share FILS AAD details to the driver by using 6407 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD. 6408 * 6409 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Device supports background radar/CAC 6410 * detection. 6411 * 6412 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE: Device can perform a MAC address 6413 * change without having to bring the underlying network device down 6414 * first. For example, in station mode this can be used to vary the 6415 * origin MAC address prior to a connection to a new AP for privacy 6416 * or other reasons. Note that certain driver specific restrictions 6417 * might apply, e.g. no scans in progress, no offchannel operations 6418 * in progress, and no active connections. 6419 * 6420 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT: Driver supports preamble puncturing in AP mode. 6421 * 6422 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN: Device supports NAN Pairing which enables 6423 * authentication, data encryption and message integrity. 6424 * 6425 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA: Device supports randomized TA 6426 * in authentication and deauthentication frames sent to unassociated peer 6427 * using @NL80211_CMD_FRAME. 6428 * 6429 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE 6430 * handling in station mode. 6431 * 6432 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE 6433 * handling in AP mode. 6434 * 6435 * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features. 6436 * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index. 6437 */ 6438 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index { 6439 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS, 6440 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM, 6441 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER, 6442 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME, 6443 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF, 6444 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL, 6445 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY, 6446 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT, 6447 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT, 6448 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA, 6449 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA, 6450 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED, 6451 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI, 6452 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST, 6453 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD, 6454 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK, 6455 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X, 6456 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME, 6457 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP, 6458 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE, 6459 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION, 6460 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL, 6461 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN, 6462 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN, 6463 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN, 6464 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD, 6465 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, 6466 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT, 6467 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */ 6468 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT, 6469 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS, 6470 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN, 6471 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT, 6472 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0, 6473 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER, 6474 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS, 6475 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING, 6476 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD, 6477 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID, 6478 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR, 6479 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD, 6480 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD, 6481 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL, 6482 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION, 6483 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, 6484 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT, 6485 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA, 6486 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS, 6487 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT, 6488 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, 6489 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS, 6490 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION, 6491 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK, 6492 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP, 6493 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY, 6494 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP, 6495 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE, 6496 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF, 6497 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT, 6498 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE, 6499 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR, 6500 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD, 6501 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND, 6502 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE, 6503 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT, 6504 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN, 6505 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA, 6506 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD, 6507 NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP, 6508 6509 /* add new features before the definition below */ 6510 NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 6511 MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1 6512 }; 6513 6514 /** 6515 * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported 6516 * protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW. 6517 * To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute. 6518 * Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported 6519 * protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a 6520 * supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded 6521 * to the host. 6522 * 6523 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1 6524 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2 6525 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P 6526 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u 6527 */ 6528 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr { 6529 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS = 1<<0, 6530 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 = 1<<1, 6531 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P = 1<<2, 6532 NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U = 1<<3, 6533 }; 6534 6535 /** 6536 * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons 6537 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be 6538 * handled by the AP is reached. 6539 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL. 6540 */ 6541 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason { 6542 NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS, 6543 NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT, 6544 }; 6545 6546 /** 6547 * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons 6548 * 6549 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified. 6550 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out. 6551 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out. 6552 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out. 6553 */ 6554 enum nl80211_timeout_reason { 6555 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED, 6556 NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN, 6557 NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH, 6558 NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC, 6559 }; 6560 6561 /** 6562 * enum nl80211_scan_flags - scan request control flags 6563 * 6564 * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling 6565 * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN 6566 * requests. 6567 * 6568 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and 6569 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only 6570 * one of them can be used in the request. 6571 * 6572 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority 6573 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning 6574 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured 6575 * as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is 6576 * dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames 6577 * will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only 6578 * when really needed 6579 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or 6580 * for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the 6581 * flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and 6582 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only 6583 * the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder 6584 * randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits, 6585 * locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed. 6586 * This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check 6587 * the nl80211 feature flags for the device. 6588 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS 6589 * request parameters IE in the probe request 6590 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses 6591 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at 6592 * rate of at least 5.5M. In case non OCE AP is discovered in the channel, 6593 * only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate. 6594 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request 6595 * tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms) 6596 * and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame, 6597 * Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers 6598 * a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of 6599 * SSID and/or RSSI. 6600 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to 6601 * accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the 6602 * scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver 6603 * implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get 6604 * impacted with this flag. 6605 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume 6606 * optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to 6607 * optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag. 6608 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan 6609 * results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum 6610 * possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best 6611 * possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning. 6612 * Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag. 6613 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe 6614 * request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being 6615 * possible. 6616 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to 6617 * only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless 6618 * added by userspace explicitly.) 6619 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with 6620 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means 6621 * %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included. 6622 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for collocated APs reported by 6623 * 2.4/5 GHz APs. When the flag is set, the scan logic will use the 6624 * information from the RNR element found in beacons/probe responses 6625 * received on the 2.4/5 GHz channels to actively scan only the 6GHz 6626 * channels on which APs are expected to be found. Note that when not set, 6627 * the scan logic would scan all 6GHz channels, but since transmission of 6628 * probe requests on non PSC channels is limited, it is highly likely that 6629 * these channels would passively be scanned. Also note that when the flag 6630 * is set, in addition to the colocated APs, PSC channels would also be 6631 * scanned if the user space has asked for it. 6632 */ 6633 enum nl80211_scan_flags { 6634 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY = 1<<0, 6635 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH = 1<<1, 6636 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP = 1<<2, 6637 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR = 1<<3, 6638 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME = 1<<4, 6639 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<5, 6640 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE = 1<<6, 6641 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION = 1<<7, 6642 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN = 1<<8, 6643 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER = 1<<9, 6644 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY = 1<<10, 6645 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN = 1<<11, 6646 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT = 1<<12, 6647 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ = 1<<13, 6648 NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ = 1<<14, 6649 }; 6650 6651 /** 6652 * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy 6653 * 6654 * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by 6655 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to 6656 * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. 6657 * 6658 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are 6659 * listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed 6660 * in ACL to authenticate. 6661 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed 6662 * in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL. 6663 */ 6664 enum nl80211_acl_policy { 6665 NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED, 6666 NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED, 6667 }; 6668 6669 /** 6670 * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode 6671 * 6672 * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode) 6673 * 6674 * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas). 6675 * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna) 6676 * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and 6677 * turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS). 6678 */ 6679 enum nl80211_smps_mode { 6680 NL80211_SMPS_OFF, 6681 NL80211_SMPS_STATIC, 6682 NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC, 6683 6684 __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST, 6685 NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1 6686 }; 6687 6688 /** 6689 * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation 6690 * 6691 * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace 6692 * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC) 6693 * 6694 * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is 6695 * now unusable. 6696 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished, 6697 * the channel is now available. 6698 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no 6699 * change to the channel status. 6700 * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is 6701 * over, channel becomes usable. 6702 * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this 6703 * non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must 6704 * be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not 6705 * applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever. 6706 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started, 6707 * should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled. 6708 */ 6709 enum nl80211_radar_event { 6710 NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED, 6711 NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED, 6712 NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED, 6713 NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED, 6714 NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED, 6715 NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED, 6716 }; 6717 6718 /** 6719 * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels 6720 * 6721 * Channel states used by the DFS code. 6722 * 6723 * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability 6724 * check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS. 6725 * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it 6726 * is therefore marked as not available. 6727 * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available. 6728 */ 6729 enum nl80211_dfs_state { 6730 NL80211_DFS_USABLE, 6731 NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE, 6732 NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE, 6733 }; 6734 6735 /** 6736 * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features 6737 * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting 6738 * wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute 6739 * %NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the 6740 * wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or 6741 * %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV. 6742 */ 6743 enum nl80211_protocol_features { 6744 NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP = 1 << 0, 6745 }; 6746 6747 /** 6748 * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers 6749 * 6750 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified. 6751 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol. 6752 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol. 6753 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol. 6754 * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last. 6755 */ 6756 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id { 6757 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC, 6758 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP, 6759 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL, 6760 NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA, 6761 /* add other protocols before this one */ 6762 NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO 6763 }; 6764 6765 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */ 6766 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION 5000 /* msec */ 6767 6768 /** 6769 * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame. 6770 * 6771 * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt() 6772 * 6773 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver. 6774 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload 6775 * the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that 6776 * advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace 6777 * to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE). 6778 */ 6779 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags { 6780 NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0, 6781 NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1, 6782 }; 6783 6784 /* 6785 * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set 6786 * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated 6787 * yet, so that's not valid so far) 6788 */ 6789 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX 0x80000000 6790 6791 /** 6792 * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data 6793 * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the 6794 * value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID 6795 * may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be 6796 * added to this file when needed. 6797 * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command 6798 */ 6799 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info { 6800 __u32 vendor_id; 6801 __u32 subcmd; 6802 }; 6803 6804 /** 6805 * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags. 6806 * 6807 * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need 6808 * to be added to TDLS Setup frames. 6809 * 6810 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable. 6811 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable. 6812 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable. 6813 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable. 6814 */ 6815 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability { 6816 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0, 6817 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1, 6818 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2, 6819 NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3, 6820 }; 6821 6822 /** 6823 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan 6824 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 6825 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In 6826 * seconds (u32). 6827 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this 6828 * scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute 6829 * because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will 6830 * make the scan plan meaningless. 6831 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number 6832 * currently defined 6833 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use 6834 */ 6835 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan { 6836 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID, 6837 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL, 6838 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS, 6839 6840 /* keep last */ 6841 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST, 6842 NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX = 6843 __NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1 6844 }; 6845 6846 /** 6847 * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters. 6848 * 6849 * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value 6850 * of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band. 6851 * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB. 6852 */ 6853 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust { 6854 __u8 band; 6855 __s8 delta; 6856 } __attribute__((packed)); 6857 6858 /** 6859 * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection. 6860 * 6861 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved. 6862 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection 6863 * is requested. 6864 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS 6865 * selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred. 6866 * When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver 6867 * shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of 6868 * this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32). 6869 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for 6870 * BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing 6871 * RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure 6872 * value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust. 6873 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number. 6874 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use. 6875 * 6876 * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT 6877 * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour 6878 * which the driver shall use. 6879 */ 6880 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr { 6881 __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID, 6882 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI, 6883 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF, 6884 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST, 6885 6886 /* keep last */ 6887 __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST, 6888 NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1 6889 }; 6890 6891 /** 6892 * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type 6893 * 6894 * Defines the function type of a NAN function 6895 * 6896 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish 6897 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe 6898 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up 6899 */ 6900 enum nl80211_nan_function_type { 6901 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, 6902 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE, 6903 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, 6904 6905 /* keep last */ 6906 __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST, 6907 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1, 6908 }; 6909 6910 /** 6911 * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type 6912 * 6913 * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames 6914 * 6915 * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited 6916 * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited 6917 */ 6918 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type { 6919 NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0, 6920 NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1, 6921 }; 6922 6923 /** 6924 * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason 6925 * 6926 * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function 6927 * 6928 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user 6929 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout 6930 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored 6931 */ 6932 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason { 6933 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST, 6934 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED, 6935 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR, 6936 }; 6937 6938 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6 6939 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff 6940 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff 6941 6942 /** 6943 * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes 6944 * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid 6945 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8). 6946 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as 6947 * specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute. 6948 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is 6949 * publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery 6950 * Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8. 6951 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited 6952 * publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to 6953 * the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag. 6954 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is 6955 * subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag. 6956 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up. 6957 * The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8. 6958 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type 6959 * is follow up. This is a u8. 6960 * The requestor instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. 6961 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the 6962 * follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute. 6963 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a 6964 * close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device. 6965 * This is a flag. 6966 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should 6967 * stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32. 6968 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service 6969 * specific info. This is a binary attribute. 6970 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute. 6971 * See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes. 6972 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested 6973 * attribute. It is a list of binary values. 6974 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a 6975 * nested attribute. It is a list of binary values. 6976 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function. 6977 * Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0. 6978 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason. 6979 * See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason. 6980 * 6981 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal 6982 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute 6983 */ 6984 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes { 6985 __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID, 6986 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE, 6987 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID, 6988 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE, 6989 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST, 6990 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE, 6991 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID, 6992 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID, 6993 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST, 6994 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE, 6995 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL, 6996 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO, 6997 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF, 6998 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER, 6999 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER, 7000 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID, 7001 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON, 7002 7003 /* keep last */ 7004 NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR, 7005 NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1 7006 }; 7007 7008 /** 7009 * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes 7010 * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid 7011 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set. 7012 * This is a flag. 7013 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if 7014 * %NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary. 7015 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if 7016 * %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8. 7017 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if 7018 * and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested 7019 * attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address. 7020 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal 7021 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute 7022 */ 7023 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes { 7024 __NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID, 7025 NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE, 7026 NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF, 7027 NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX, 7028 NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS, 7029 7030 /* keep last */ 7031 NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR, 7032 NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1, 7033 }; 7034 7035 /** 7036 * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes 7037 * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid 7038 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the 7039 * match. This is a nested attribute. 7040 * See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes. 7041 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function 7042 * that caused the match. This is a nested attribute. 7043 * See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes. 7044 * 7045 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal 7046 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute 7047 */ 7048 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes { 7049 __NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID, 7050 NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL, 7051 NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER, 7052 7053 /* keep last */ 7054 NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR, 7055 NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1 7056 }; 7057 7058 /** 7059 * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external 7060 * authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION. 7061 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication. 7062 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication. 7063 */ 7064 enum nl80211_external_auth_action { 7065 NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START, 7066 NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT, 7067 }; 7068 7069 /** 7070 * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement 7071 * responder attributes 7072 * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7073 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled 7074 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element 7075 * (9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10), 7076 * i.e. starting with the measurement token 7077 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVIC: The content of Measurement Report Element 7078 * (9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13), 7079 * i.e. starting with the measurement token 7080 * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7081 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute. 7082 */ 7083 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes { 7084 __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID, 7085 7086 NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED, 7087 NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI, 7088 NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC, 7089 7090 /* keep last */ 7091 __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST, 7092 NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7093 }; 7094 7095 /* 7096 * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics 7097 * 7098 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS 7099 * when getting FTM responder statistics. 7100 * 7101 * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved 7102 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames 7103 * were ssfully answered (u32) 7104 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the 7105 * frames were successfully answered (u32) 7106 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32) 7107 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32) 7108 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32) 7109 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an 7110 * indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec) 7111 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers - 7112 * triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation 7113 * phase with the responder (u32) 7114 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests 7115 * - initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled 7116 * FTM slot (u32) 7117 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of 7118 * scheduled window (u32) 7119 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore 7120 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal 7121 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute 7122 */ 7123 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats { 7124 __NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID, 7125 NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM, 7126 NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM, 7127 NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM, 7128 NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM, 7129 NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM, 7130 NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC, 7131 NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM, 7132 NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM, 7133 NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM, 7134 NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD, 7135 7136 /* keep last */ 7137 __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST, 7138 NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1 7139 }; 7140 7141 /** 7142 * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types 7143 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble 7144 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble 7145 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble 7146 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble 7147 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble 7148 */ 7149 enum nl80211_preamble { 7150 NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY, 7151 NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT, 7152 NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT, 7153 NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG, 7154 NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE, 7155 }; 7156 7157 /** 7158 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types 7159 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use 7160 * these numbers also for attributes 7161 * 7162 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement 7163 * 7164 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal 7165 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number 7166 */ 7167 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type { 7168 NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID, 7169 7170 NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM, 7171 7172 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES, 7173 NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1 7174 }; 7175 7176 /** 7177 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status 7178 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully 7179 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused 7180 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out 7181 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent 7182 * reason may be available in the response data 7183 */ 7184 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status { 7185 NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS, 7186 NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED, 7187 NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT, 7188 NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE, 7189 }; 7190 7191 /** 7192 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes 7193 * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7194 * 7195 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement 7196 * type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the 7197 * enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req. 7198 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported 7199 * (flag attribute) 7200 * 7201 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal 7202 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7203 */ 7204 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req { 7205 __NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID, 7206 7207 NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA, 7208 NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF, 7209 7210 /* keep last */ 7211 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS, 7212 NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1 7213 }; 7214 7215 /** 7216 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes 7217 * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7218 * 7219 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement 7220 * type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums 7221 * named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp. 7222 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status 7223 * (using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.) 7224 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the 7225 * result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to 7226 * more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds) 7227 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface 7228 * doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured. 7229 * This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested 7230 * (u64, usec) 7231 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially 7232 * (*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but 7233 * the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single 7234 * result. 7235 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore 7236 * 7237 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal 7238 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7239 */ 7240 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp { 7241 __NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID, 7242 7243 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA, 7244 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS, 7245 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME, 7246 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF, 7247 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL, 7248 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD, 7249 7250 /* keep last */ 7251 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS, 7252 NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1 7253 }; 7254 7255 /** 7256 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement 7257 * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7258 * 7259 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address 7260 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level 7261 * attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc. 7262 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by 7263 * measurement type, with attributes from the 7264 * &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside. 7265 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by 7266 * measurement type, with attributes from the 7267 * &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside. 7268 * 7269 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal 7270 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7271 */ 7272 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs { 7273 __NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID, 7274 7275 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR, 7276 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN, 7277 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ, 7278 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP, 7279 7280 /* keep last */ 7281 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS, 7282 NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1, 7283 }; 7284 7285 /** 7286 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes 7287 * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7288 * 7289 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability 7290 * advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers 7291 * measurements can be done with in a single request 7292 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability 7293 * indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in 7294 * measurement results 7295 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability 7296 * indicating that MAC address randomization is supported. 7297 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device, 7298 * this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and 7299 * type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums 7300 * named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa. 7301 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is 7302 * meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the 7303 * sub-attributes taken from 7304 * &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs. 7305 * 7306 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal 7307 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7308 */ 7309 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs { 7310 __NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID, 7311 7312 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS, 7313 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF, 7314 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR, 7315 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA, 7316 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS, 7317 7318 /* keep last */ 7319 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR, 7320 NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1 7321 }; 7322 7323 /** 7324 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities 7325 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7326 * 7327 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode 7328 * is supported 7329 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP 7330 * mode is supported 7331 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI 7332 * data can be requested during the measurement 7333 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic 7334 * location data can be requested during the measurement 7335 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits 7336 * from &enum nl80211_preamble. 7337 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from 7338 * &enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel 7339 * bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be 7340 * configured to allow for other measurements types with different 7341 * bandwidth requirement in the same measurement. 7342 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating 7343 * the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything 7344 * is valid) 7345 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating 7346 * the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid) 7347 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if 7348 * trigger based ranging measurement is supported 7349 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating 7350 * if non trigger based ranging measurement is supported 7351 * 7352 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal 7353 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7354 */ 7355 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa { 7356 __NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID, 7357 7358 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP, 7359 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP, 7360 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI, 7361 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC, 7362 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES, 7363 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS, 7364 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT, 7365 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST, 7366 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED, 7367 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED, 7368 7369 /* keep last */ 7370 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR, 7371 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1 7372 }; 7373 7374 /** 7375 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes 7376 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7377 * 7378 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag) 7379 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see 7380 * &enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32) 7381 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in 7382 * 802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element" 7383 * (u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference") 7384 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units 7385 * of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0) 7386 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016 7387 * Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with 7388 * default 15 i.e. "no preference") 7389 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames 7390 * requested per burst 7391 * (u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference") 7392 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries 7393 * (u8, default 3) 7394 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag) 7395 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data 7396 * (flag) 7397 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging 7398 * measurement (flag). 7399 * This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are 7400 * mutually exclusive. 7401 * if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor 7402 * %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based 7403 * ranging will be used. 7404 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non trigger based 7405 * ranging measurement (flag) 7406 * This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are 7407 * mutually exclusive. 7408 * if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor 7409 * %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based 7410 * ranging will be used. 7411 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only 7412 * valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or 7413 * %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set. 7414 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR: optional. The BSS color of the 7415 * responder. Only valid if %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED 7416 * or %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED is set. 7417 * 7418 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal 7419 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7420 */ 7421 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req { 7422 __NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID, 7423 7424 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP, 7425 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE, 7426 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP, 7427 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD, 7428 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION, 7429 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST, 7430 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES, 7431 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI, 7432 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC, 7433 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED, 7434 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED, 7435 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK, 7436 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR, 7437 7438 /* keep last */ 7439 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR, 7440 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1 7441 }; 7442 7443 /** 7444 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons 7445 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used 7446 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder 7447 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement 7448 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is 7449 * on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd 7450 * try and get no response) 7451 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM 7452 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps 7453 * received 7454 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry 7455 * later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME) 7456 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed 7457 * by the peer and are no longer supported 7458 */ 7459 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons { 7460 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED, 7461 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE, 7462 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED, 7463 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL, 7464 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE, 7465 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP, 7466 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, 7467 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS, 7468 }; 7469 7470 /** 7471 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes 7472 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid 7473 * 7474 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason 7475 * (u32, optional) 7476 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported 7477 * as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and 7478 * the top level will indicate partial results (u32) 7479 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames 7480 * transmitted (u32, optional) 7481 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames 7482 * that were acknowleged (u32, optional) 7483 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the 7484 * busy peer (u32, seconds) 7485 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent 7486 * used by the responder (similar to request, u8) 7487 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by 7488 * the responder (similar to request, u8) 7489 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used 7490 * by the responder (similar to request, u8) 7491 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action 7492 * frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm) 7493 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action 7494 * frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm) 7495 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the 7496 * FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info 7497 * attributes) 7498 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM 7499 * action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs) 7500 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional 7501 * but one of RTT/DIST must be present) 7502 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that 7503 * standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional) 7504 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds, 7505 * optional) 7506 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional 7507 * but one of RTT/DIST must be present) 7508 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note 7509 * that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional) 7510 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional) 7511 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional); 7512 * this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016 7513 * 9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement 7514 * Type 8. 7515 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer 7516 * (binary, optional); 7517 * this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016 7518 * 9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement 7519 * Type 11. 7520 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only 7521 * 7522 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal 7523 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number 7524 */ 7525 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp { 7526 __NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID, 7527 7528 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON, 7529 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX, 7530 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS, 7531 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES, 7532 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME, 7533 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP, 7534 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION, 7535 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST, 7536 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG, 7537 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD, 7538 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE, 7539 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE, 7540 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG, 7541 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE, 7542 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD, 7543 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG, 7544 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE, 7545 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD, 7546 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI, 7547 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC, 7548 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD, 7549 7550 /* keep last */ 7551 NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR, 7552 NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1 7553 }; 7554 7555 /** 7556 * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes 7557 * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7558 * 7559 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset. 7560 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset. 7561 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum 7562 * tx power offset. 7563 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color 7564 * values used by members of the SRG. 7565 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial 7566 * BSSID values used by members of the SRG. 7567 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element. 7568 * 7569 * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7570 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute. 7571 */ 7572 enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes { 7573 __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID, 7574 7575 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET, 7576 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET, 7577 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET, 7578 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP, 7579 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP, 7580 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL, 7581 7582 /* keep last */ 7583 __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST, 7584 NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7585 }; 7586 7587 /** 7588 * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes 7589 * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7590 * 7591 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color. 7592 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled. 7593 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used.. 7594 * 7595 * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7596 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute. 7597 */ 7598 enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes { 7599 __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID, 7600 7601 NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR, 7602 NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED, 7603 NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL, 7604 7605 /* keep last */ 7606 __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST, 7607 NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7608 }; 7609 7610 /** 7611 * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes 7612 * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7613 * 7614 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag 7615 * attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in 7616 * %NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES 7617 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported 7618 * AKM suites for the specified interface types. 7619 * 7620 * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7621 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute. 7622 */ 7623 enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes { 7624 __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID, 7625 7626 NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES, 7627 NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES, 7628 7629 /* keep last */ 7630 __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST, 7631 NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7632 }; 7633 7634 /** 7635 * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration 7636 * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 7637 * 7638 * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7639 * 7640 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU). 7641 * Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit) 7642 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU). 7643 * Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit). If set to 0, the feature is disabled. 7644 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action 7645 * frame including the headers. 7646 * 7647 * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7648 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute 7649 */ 7650 enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes { 7651 __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID, 7652 7653 NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN, 7654 NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX, 7655 NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL, 7656 7657 /* keep last */ 7658 __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST, 7659 NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1 7660 }; 7661 7662 /* 7663 * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and 7664 * mandatory fields. 7665 */ 7666 #define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42 7667 7668 /** 7669 * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe 7670 * response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz. 7671 * 7672 * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7673 * 7674 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU). 7675 * Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 7676 * 26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning). If set to 0, the feature is 7677 * disabled. 7678 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 7679 * frame template (binary). 7680 * 7681 * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7682 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute 7683 */ 7684 enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes { 7685 __NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID, 7686 7687 NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT, 7688 NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL, 7689 7690 /* keep last */ 7691 __NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST, 7692 NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX = 7693 __NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1 7694 }; 7695 7696 /** 7697 * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE 7698 * derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is 7699 * used. 7700 * 7701 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that 7702 * attribute is not present from userspace. 7703 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only 7704 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only 7705 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element 7706 * can be used. 7707 */ 7708 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism { 7709 NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED, 7710 NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK, 7711 NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT, 7712 NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH, 7713 }; 7714 7715 /** 7716 * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs 7717 * 7718 * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit 7719 * 7720 */ 7721 enum nl80211_sar_type { 7722 NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER, 7723 7724 /* add new type here */ 7725 7726 /* Keep last */ 7727 NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE, 7728 }; 7729 7730 /** 7731 * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec 7732 * 7733 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type. 7734 * 7735 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power 7736 * limit specifications. Each specification contains a set 7737 * of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs. 7738 * 7739 * For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER 7740 * and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX. 7741 * 7742 * For sar_capa dump, it contains array of 7743 * %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ 7744 * and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ. 7745 * 7746 * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7747 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute 7748 * 7749 * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC 7750 */ 7751 enum nl80211_sar_attrs { 7752 __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID, 7753 7754 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE, 7755 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS, 7756 7757 __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST, 7758 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7759 }; 7760 7761 /** 7762 * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs 7763 * 7764 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual 7765 * power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is 7766 * NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm). 7767 * 0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range. 7768 * 7769 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the 7770 * index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation 7771 * is applied to this range. 7772 * 7773 * Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver, 7774 * and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't 7775 * have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the 7776 * %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any 7777 * value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power 7778 * limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range. 7779 * It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation. 7780 * 7781 * Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation. 7782 * 7783 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start 7784 * frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy. 7785 * It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz. 7786 * 7787 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end 7788 * frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy. 7789 * It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz. 7790 * 7791 * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal 7792 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute 7793 */ 7794 enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs { 7795 __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID, 7796 7797 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER, 7798 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX, 7799 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ, 7800 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ, 7801 7802 __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST, 7803 NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1, 7804 }; 7805 7806 /** 7807 * enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes - multiple BSSID (MBSSID) and enhanced 7808 * multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA) in AP mode. 7809 * Kernel uses some of these attributes to advertise driver's support for 7810 * MBSSID and EMA. 7811 * Remaining attributes should be used by the userspace to configure the 7812 * features. 7813 * 7814 * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid 7815 * 7816 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES: Used by the kernel to advertise 7817 * the maximum number of MBSSID interfaces supported by the driver. 7818 * Driver should indicate MBSSID support by setting 7819 * wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces to a value more than or equal to 2. 7820 * 7821 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY: Used by the kernel 7822 * to advertise the maximum profile periodicity supported by the driver 7823 * if EMA is enabled. Driver should indicate EMA support to the userspace 7824 * by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to 7825 * a non-zero value. 7826 * 7827 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX: Mandatory parameter to pass the index of 7828 * this BSS (u8) in the multiple BSSID set. 7829 * Value must be set to 0 for the transmitting interface and non-zero for 7830 * all non-transmitting interfaces. The userspace will be responsible 7831 * for using unique indices for the interfaces. 7832 * Range: 0 to wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces-1. 7833 * 7834 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX: Mandatory parameter for 7835 * a non-transmitted profile which provides the interface index (u32) of 7836 * the transmitted profile. The value must match one of the interface 7837 * indices advertised by the kernel. Optional if the interface being set up 7838 * is the transmitting one, however, if provided then the value must match 7839 * the interface index of the same. 7840 * 7841 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA: Flag used to enable EMA AP feature. 7842 * Setting this flag is permitted only if the driver advertises EMA support 7843 * by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to non-zero. 7844 * 7845 * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST: Internal 7846 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute 7847 */ 7848 enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes { 7849 __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID, 7850 7851 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES, 7852 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY, 7853 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX, 7854 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX, 7855 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA, 7856 7857 /* keep last */ 7858 __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST, 7859 NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST - 1, 7860 }; 7861 7862 /** 7863 * enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags 7864 * 7865 * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external 7866 * authentication. 7867 * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT: Userspace supports SA Query 7868 * procedures offload to driver. If driver advertises 7869 * %NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD in AP SME features, userspace shall 7870 * ignore SA Query procedures and validations when this flag is set by 7871 * userspace. 7872 */ 7873 enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags { 7874 NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = 1 << 0, 7875 NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT = 1 << 1, 7876 }; 7877 7878 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */ 7879